blob: a37f54c0124e47cad699c97089be3ce09d5f0807 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100490 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100491 - tune.lua.session-timeout
492 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100493 - tune.maxaccept
494 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200495 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200496 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100497 - tune.rcvbuf.client
498 - tune.rcvbuf.server
499 - tune.sndbuf.client
500 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100501 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100502 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200503 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100504 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200505 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100506 - tune.zlib.memlevel
507 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509 * Debugging
510 - debug
511 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515------------------------------------
516
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517ca-base <dir>
518 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200519 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
520 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522chroot <jail dir>
523 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
524 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
525 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
526 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
527 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
528 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100529
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100530cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
531 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
532 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
533 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100534 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
535 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
536 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
537 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
538 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
539 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
540 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
541 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
542 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
543 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100544
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200545crt-base <dir>
546 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
547 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
548 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550daemon
551 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
552 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
553 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
554
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900555external-check
556 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
557 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
558 See "option external-check".
559
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560gid <number>
561 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
562 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
563 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100564 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
565 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568group <group name>
569 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
570 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200572log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
574 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100575 configured with "log global".
576
577 <address> can be one of:
578
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100579 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100583 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
584 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
585 port).
586
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100587 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
588 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
589 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
590 writeable).
591
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100592 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
593 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
594 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
595 in Bourne shell.
596
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200597 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
598 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
599 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
600 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
601 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
602 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
603 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
604 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
605 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
606 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
607 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
608
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100609 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610
611 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
612 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
613 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
614
615 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200616 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
617 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
618 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
619 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
620 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
621 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200623 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100625log-send-hostname [<string>]
626 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
627 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
628 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
629 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
630 the logs.
631
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000632log-tag <string>
633 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
634 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
635 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100636 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000637
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638lua-load <file>
639 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
640 used multiple times.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642nbproc <number>
643 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
644 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
645 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
646 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
647 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
648
649pidfile <pidfile>
650 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
651 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
652 starting the process. See also "daemon".
653
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100654stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200655 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
656 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
657 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
658 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
659 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
660 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100661 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200662 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
663 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200664
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100665ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
667 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300668 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
670 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
671 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
672 "bind" keyword for more information.
673
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100674ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
676 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
677 keyword to see available options.
678
679 Example:
680 global
681 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
682
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100683ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
685 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300686 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100687 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
688 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
689 information.
690
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100691ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
693 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
694 keyword to see available options.
695
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100696ssl-server-verify [none|required]
697 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
698 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
699 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
700
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200701stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
702 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
703 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
704 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
705 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200706
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200707 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
708 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
709 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200710
711stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
712 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
713 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100714 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200715
716stats maxconn <connections>
717 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
718 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720uid <number>
721 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
722 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
723 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
724 one. See also "gid" and "user".
725
726ulimit-n <number>
727 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
728 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
729 option.
730
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100731unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
732 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
733
734 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
735 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
736 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
737 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
738 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
739 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
740 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
741 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
742 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
743 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
744
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745user <user name>
746 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
747 See also "uid" and "group".
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200749node <name>
750 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
751
752 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
753 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
754 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
755 traffic.
756
757description <text>
758 Add a text that describes the instance.
759
760 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
761 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
762 "<" and ">" characters.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007653.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766-----------------------
767
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200768max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
769 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
770 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
771 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
772 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
773 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
774 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
775 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
776 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778maxconn <number>
779 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
780 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
781 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200782 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
783 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
784 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
785 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100786 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
787 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
788 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
789 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
790 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200792maxconnrate <number>
793 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
794 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
795 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
796 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
797 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
798 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
799 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
800 fairness.
801
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100802maxcomprate <number>
803 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300804 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100805 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
806 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
807 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
808 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
809 default value.
810
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100811maxcompcpuusage <number>
812 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
813 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
814 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
815 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
816 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
817 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
818 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
819 process down and from introducing high latencies.
820
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100821maxpipes <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
823 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
824 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
825 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
826 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
827 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
828
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200829maxsessrate <number>
830 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
831 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
832 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
833 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
834 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
835 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
836 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
837 fairness.
838
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200839maxsslconn <number>
840 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
841 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
842 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
843 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
844 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
845 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
846 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100847 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
848 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
849 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
850 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
851 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
852 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
853 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200854
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200855maxsslrate <number>
856 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
857 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
858 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
859 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
860 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
861 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
862 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
863 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
864 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
865 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
866
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100867maxzlibmem <number>
868 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
869 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
870 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100871 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
872 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
873 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
874
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200875noepoll
876 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
877 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100878 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879
880nokqueue
881 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
882 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
883 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
884
885nopoll
886 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
887 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100888 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100889 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200890
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100891nosplice
892 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
893 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
894 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100895 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100896 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
897 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
898 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
899 "option splice-response".
900
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300901nogetaddrinfo
902 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
903 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
904
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200905spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900906 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
907 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
908 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
909 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
910 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
911 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200912
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100913tune.buffers.limit <number>
914 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
915 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
916 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
917 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
918 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
919 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
920 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
921 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
922 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
923 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
924 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
925 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
926 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
927 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
928 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
929
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100930tune.buffers.reserve <number>
931 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
932 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
933 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
934 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
935
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200936tune.bufsize <number>
937 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
938 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
939 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
940 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
941 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
942 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
943 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
944 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400945 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
946 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
947 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200948
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200949tune.chksize <number>
950 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
951 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
952 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
953 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
954 checks whenever possible.
955
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100956tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
957 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
958 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
959 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
960 this value. The default value is 1.
961
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100962tune.http.cookielen <number>
963 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
964 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
965 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
966 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
967 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
968 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
969 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
970 to change this value.
971
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200972tune.http.maxhdr <number>
973 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
974 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
975 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
976 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
977 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
978 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
979 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
980 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
981 limit too high.
982
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100983tune.idletimer <timeout>
984 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
985 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
986 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
987 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
988 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
989 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
990 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
991 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
992 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
993
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
995 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
996 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
997 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
998 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
999 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1000 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1001 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1002
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001003tune.lua.maxmem
1004 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1005 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1006 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1007 memory.
1008
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001009tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1010 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1011 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1012 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1013 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1014 4s.
1015
1016tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1017 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1018 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1019 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1020 check servers.
1021
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001022tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001023 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1024 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1025 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1026 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1027 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1028 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1029 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1030 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1031 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1032 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001033
1034tune.maxpollevents <number>
1035 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1036 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1037 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1038 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1039 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1040
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001041tune.maxrewrite <number>
1042 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1043 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1044 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1045 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1046 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1047 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1048 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1049 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1050 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1051 bufsize.
1052
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001053tune.pipesize <number>
1054 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1055 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1056 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1057 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1058 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1059 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1060
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001061tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1062tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1063 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1064 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1065 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1066 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1067 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1068 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1069 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1070
1071tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1072tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1073 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1074 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1075 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1076 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1077 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1078 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1079 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1080 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1081 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1082 notifying haproxy again.
1083
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001084tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001085 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1086 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1087 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001088 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001089 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1090 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1091 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1092 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1093 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001094 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1095 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001096
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1098 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1099 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1100 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1101 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1102 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1103 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1104
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001105tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1106 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001107 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001108 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1109 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1110 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1111 being used for too long.
1112
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001113tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1114 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1115 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1116 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1117 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1118 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1119 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1120 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1121 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1122 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1123 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1125 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001126
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001127tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1128 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1129 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1130 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1131 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1132 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1133 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1134 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1135 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1136
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001137tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1138 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001139 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001140 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1141 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1142 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1143
1144tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1145 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1146 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1147 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1148 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011503.3. Debugging
1151--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152
1153debug
1154 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1155 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1156 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1157 system startup.
1158
1159quiet
1160 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1161 line argument "-q".
1162
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011643.4. Userlists
1165--------------
1166It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1167http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1168it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1169
1170userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001171 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001172 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1173
1174group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001175 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001176 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1177 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1178
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001179user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1180 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001181 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1182 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001183 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1184 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001185 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001186 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001187
1188
1189 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001190 userlist L1
1191 group G1 users tiger,scott
1192 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001193
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001194 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1195 user scott insecure-password elgato
1196 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001197
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001198 userlist L2
1199 group G1
1200 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001201
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001202 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1203 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1204 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001205
1206 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001207
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001208
12093.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001210----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001211It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1212haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1213pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1214identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1215or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1216Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1217known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1218the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1219process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1220during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1221tables.
1222
1223peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001224 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1226
1227peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1228 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1229 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1230 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1231 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1232 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1233 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1234
1235 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1236 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1237
1238 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1239 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1240 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1241 across all peers.
1242
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001243 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1244 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1245 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1246
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001247 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001248 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001249 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1250 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1251 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001252
1253 backend mybackend
1254 mode tcp
1255 balance roundrobin
1256 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1257 stick on src
1258
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001259 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1260 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001261
1262
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012633.6. Mailers
1264------------
1265It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1266If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1267in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1268
1269mailer <mailersect>
1270 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1271 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1272
1273mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1274 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1275
1276 Example:
1277 mailers mymailers
1278 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1279 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1280
1281 backend mybackend
1282 mode tcp
1283 balance roundrobin
1284
1285 email-alert mailers mymailers
1286 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1287 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1288
1289 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1290 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1291
1292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001295
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1297 - defaults <name>
1298 - frontend <name>
1299 - backend <name>
1300 - listen <name>
1301
1302A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1303its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1304section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306
1307A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1308connections.
1309
1310A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1311to forward incoming connections.
1312
1313A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1314parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001316All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1317'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1318case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1319
1320Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1321logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1322proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1323However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1324name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1325
1326Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1327and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001328bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001329protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1330modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1331arbitrary criteria.
1332
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001333In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1334a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1335the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1336
1337 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1338 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1339 between responses and new requests.
1340
1341 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1342 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1343 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1344 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1345
1346 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1347 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1348 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1349
1350 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1351 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1352 client-facing connection remains open.
1353
1354 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1355 after the end of the response.
1356
1357The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1358frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1359following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1360weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1361
1362 Backend mode
1363
1364 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1365 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1366 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1367 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1368 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1369 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1370 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1371 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1372 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1373 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1374 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1379--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001381The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1382limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1383they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1384limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001385marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001386option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001387and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1388with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1389specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001391
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001392 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1393------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1394acl - X X X
1395appsession - - X X
1396backlog X X X -
1397balance X - X X
1398bind - X X -
1399bind-process X X X X
1400block - X X X
1401capture cookie - X X -
1402capture request header - X X -
1403capture response header - X X -
1404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1407cookie X - X X
1408default-server X - X X
1409default_backend X X X -
1410description - X X X
1411disabled X X X X
1412dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001413email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001414email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001415email-alert mailers X X X X
1416email-alert myhostname X X X X
1417email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418enabled X X X X
1419errorfile X X X X
1420errorloc X X X X
1421errorloc302 X X X X
1422-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1423errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001424force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425fullconn X - X X
1426grace X X X X
1427hash-type X - X X
1428http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001429http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001430http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001431http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001432http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001433http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001435ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001436log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001437log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001438log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001439max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440maxconn X X X -
1441mode X X X X
1442monitor fail - X X -
1443monitor-net X X X -
1444monitor-uri X X X -
1445option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1446option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1447option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1448option allbackups (*) X - X X
1449option checkcache (*) X - X X
1450option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1451option contstats (*) X X X -
1452option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1453option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1454option forceclose (*) X X X X
1455-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1456option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001457option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001458option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001459option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001460option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001461option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1463option httpchk X - X X
1464option httpclose (*) X X X X
1465option httplog X X X X
1466option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001467option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001468option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001469option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001470option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1471option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1472option logasap (*) X X X -
1473option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001474option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001475option nolinger (*) X X X X
1476option originalto X X X X
1477option persist (*) X - X X
1478option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001479option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001480option smtpchk X - X X
1481option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1482option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1483option splice-request (*) X X X X
1484option splice-response (*) X X X X
1485option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1486option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1487-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001488option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001489option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1490option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1491option tcpka X X X X
1492option tcplog X X X X
1493option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001494external-check command X - X X
1495external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001496persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1497rate-limit sessions X X X -
1498redirect - X X X
1499redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1500redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1501reqadd - X X X
1502reqallow - X X X
1503reqdel - X X X
1504reqdeny - X X X
1505reqiallow - X X X
1506reqidel - X X X
1507reqideny - X X X
1508reqipass - X X X
1509reqirep - X X X
1510reqisetbe - X X X
1511reqitarpit - X X X
1512reqpass - X X X
1513reqrep - X X X
1514-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1515reqsetbe - X X X
1516reqtarpit - X X X
1517retries X - X X
1518rspadd - X X X
1519rspdel - X X X
1520rspdeny - X X X
1521rspidel - X X X
1522rspideny - X X X
1523rspirep - X X X
1524rsprep - X X X
1525server - - X X
1526source X - X X
1527srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001528stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001529stats auth X - X X
1530stats enable X - X X
1531stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001532stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001533stats realm X - X X
1534stats refresh X - X X
1535stats scope X - X X
1536stats show-desc X - X X
1537stats show-legends X - X X
1538stats show-node X - X X
1539stats uri X - X X
1540-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1541stick match - - X X
1542stick on - - X X
1543stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001544stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001545stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001546tcp-check connect - - X X
1547tcp-check expect - - X X
1548tcp-check send - - X X
1549tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001550tcp-request connection - X X -
1551tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001552tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001553tcp-response content - - X X
1554tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001555timeout check X - X X
1556timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001557timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001558timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1559timeout connect X - X X
1560timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1561timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1562timeout http-request X X X X
1563timeout queue X - X X
1564timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001565timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001566timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1567timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001568timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001569transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001570unique-id-format X X X -
1571unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001572use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001573use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1575 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1579---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
1581This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1582
1583
1584acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1585 Declare or complete an access list.
1586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1587 no | yes | yes | yes
1588 Example:
1589 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1590 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1591 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001593 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001594
1595
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001596appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1597 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1600 no | no | yes | yes
1601 Arguments :
1602 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1603 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1604
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001605 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 checked in each cookie value.
1607
1608 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1609 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1610 milliseconds.
1611
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001612 request-learn
1613 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1614 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1615 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1616 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1617 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1618 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1619
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001620 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1621 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1622 data following this prefix.
1623
1624 Example :
1625 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1626
1627 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1628 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1629
1630 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1631 2 modes are currently supported :
1632 - path-parameters :
1633 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1634 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1635 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1636 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1637 - query-string :
1638 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1639 query string.
1640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1642 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1643 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1644 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001645 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1646 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1647 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001648 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1649 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1650
1651 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1652
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001653 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1654 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1655 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 Example :
1658 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1659
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001660 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1661 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662
1663
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001664backlog <conns>
1665 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1667 yes | yes | yes | no
1668 Arguments :
1669 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1670 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001671 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001672
1673 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1674 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1675 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1676 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1677 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1678 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1679 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1680 backlog parameter.
1681
1682 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1683 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1684 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1685
1686 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1687
1688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001690balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1693 yes | no | yes | yes
1694 Arguments :
1695 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1696 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1697 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1698 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1699
1700 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1701 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1702 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1703 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001704 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001705 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001706 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1707 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1708 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1709 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1710 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1711 it, so that you don't worry.
1712
1713 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1714 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1715 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1716 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1717 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1718 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1719 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1720 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001722 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1723 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1724 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1725 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1726 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1727 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1728 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1729 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1730
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001731 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001732 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001733 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1734 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001735 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001736 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1737 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1738 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1739 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1740 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001741 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1742 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1743 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1744 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1745 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1746 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1749 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1750 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1751 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1752 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1753 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1754 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1755 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001756 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001758 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1759 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1760 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001762 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1763 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1764 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1765 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1766 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1767 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1768 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1769 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1770 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1771 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1772 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1773 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001775 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001776 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1777 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1778 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1779 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1780 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1781 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1782 URIs start with a leading "/".
1783
1784 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1785 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1786 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1787 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001790 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1791
1792 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001793 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1794 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001795 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1796 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1797 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1798 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001799 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001800 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1801 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001802
1803 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1804 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1805 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1806 server will receive the request.
1807
1808 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1809 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1810 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1811 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1812 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001813 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1814 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1815 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001817 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1818 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1819 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1820 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1821 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001823 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001824 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1825 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1826 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1827
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001828 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1829 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1830 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1831
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001832 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001833 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001834 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1835 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1836 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1837 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1838 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1839 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001840 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001841 used instead.
1842
1843 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1844 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1845 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1846 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1847
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001848 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1849 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1850 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1851
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001852 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001855 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1856 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001857
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001858 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1859 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1860 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
1862 Examples :
1863 balance roundrobin
1864 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001865 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001866 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1867 balance hdr(host)
1868 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001869
1870 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1871 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001873 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001874 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1875 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1876 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1877 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1878
1879 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1880 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1881 defaults to 16 kB.
1882
1883 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1884 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1885
1886 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1887 Round Robin.
1888
1889 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1890 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1891 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1892 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1893
1894 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1895
1896 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001897 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001898 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1899 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1900 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001902 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1903 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001904
1905
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001906bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1907bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001908 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1910 no | yes | yes | no
1911 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001912 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1913 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1914 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1915 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001916 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001917 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1918 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1919 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1920 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1921 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1922 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1923 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001924 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1925 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1926 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1927 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1928 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1929 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1930 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001931 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1932 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1933 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001934 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1935 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1936 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1937 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001938
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001939 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1940 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001941 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1942 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1943 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001944 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1945 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1946 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1947 the range.
1948
1949 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1950 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1951 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1952 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1953 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1954 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1955 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001956 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001957 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001959 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1960 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1961 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1962 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1963 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1964 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1965 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1966 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001968 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1969 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1970 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1971 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1974 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1975 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1976 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1977 in a frontend.
1978
1979 Example :
1980 listen http_proxy
1981 bind :80,:443
1982 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001983 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001985 listen http_https_proxy
1986 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001987 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001988
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001989 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1990 bind ipv6@:80
1991 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1992 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1993
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001994 listen external_bind_app1
1995 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1996
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001997 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001998 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001999
2000
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002001bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002002 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2004 yes | yes | yes | yes
2005 Arguments :
2006 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2007 may be used to override a default value.
2008
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002009 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002010 option may be combined with other numbers.
2011
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002012 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002013 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2014 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2015 missing from all processes.
2016
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002017 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002018 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002019 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2020 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2021 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2022 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002023
2024 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2025 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2026 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2027 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2028 and 'even' instances.
2029
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002030 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2031 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2032 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2033 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002034
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002035 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2036 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2037
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002038 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2039 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2040 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2041
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002042 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2043 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2044
2045 Example :
2046 listen app_ip1
2047 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002048 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002049
2050 listen app_ip2
2051 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002052 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002053
2054 listen management
2055 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002056 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002057
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002058 listen management
2059 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2060 bind-process 1-4
2061
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002062 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002063
2064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065block { if | unless } <condition>
2066 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2068 no | yes | yes | yes
2069
2070 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2071 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002072 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002073 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2075 "block" statements per instance.
2076
2077 Example:
2078 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2079 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2080 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2081 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085
2086capture cookie <name> len <length>
2087 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2089 no | yes | yes | no
2090 Arguments :
2091 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2092 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2093 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2094 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2095 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2096
2097 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2098 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2099 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2100 right if it exceeds <length>.
2101
2102 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2103 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2104 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2105 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2106
2107 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2108 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2109 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2110
2111 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2112 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2113 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002114 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2115 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2116 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117
2118 Example:
2119 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2120
2121 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002122 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
2124
2125capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002126 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 no | yes | yes | no
2129 Arguments :
2130 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002131 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2133 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2134 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2135
2136 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2137 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2138 it exceeds <length>.
2139
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002140 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2142 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002143 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2144 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2145 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2146 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002147 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002148 environments to find where the request came from.
2149
2150 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2151 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2152 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2153 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002155 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2156 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2157 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2158 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2159 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160
2161 Example:
2162 capture request header Host len 15
2163 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2164 capture request header Referrer len 15
2165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002166 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167 about logging.
2168
2169
2170capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002171 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 no | yes | yes | no
2174 Arguments :
2175 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002176 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2178 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2179 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2180
2181 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2182 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2183 it exceeds <length>.
2184
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002185 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2187 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2188 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002189 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2190 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2191 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2192 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002194 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2195 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2196 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2197 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2198 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199
2200 Example:
2201 capture response header Content-length len 9
2202 capture response header Location len 15
2203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002204 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 about logging.
2206
2207
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002208clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | yes | yes | no
2212 Arguments :
2213 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2215 as explained at the top of this document.
2216
2217 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2218 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2219 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2220 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2221 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2222 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2223 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2224 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002225 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2227 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2228
2229 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2230 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2231 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2232 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2233 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2234 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2235
2236 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2237 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2238
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002239 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2240 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002242compression algo <algorithm> ...
2243compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002244compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002245 Enable HTTP compression.
2246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2247 yes | yes | yes | yes
2248 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002249 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2250 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2251 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2252
2253 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002254 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2255 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2256 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002257
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002258 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2259 support for zlib was built in.
2260
2261 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2262 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2263 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2264 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2265 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2266 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002267
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002268 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2269 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2270 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2271 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2272 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2273 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2274 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2275 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002276
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002277 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002278 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002279 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2280 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2281 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2282 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2283 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002284
2285 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2286 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2287 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2288 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2289 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002290 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2291 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2292 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2293 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2294 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002295 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2296 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002297
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002298 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002299 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2300 "Accept-Encoding" header
2301 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002302 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002303 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2304 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002305 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2306 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2307 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2308 "multipart"
2309 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2310 header
2311 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2312 and later
2313 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2314 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002315
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002316 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2317 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002318
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002319 Examples :
2320 compression algo gzip
2321 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002323contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2326 yes | no | yes | yes
2327 Arguments :
2328 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2330 as explained at the top of this document.
2331
2332 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002333 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002334 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2336 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2337 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2338 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2339
2340 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2341 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2342 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2343 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2344 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2345 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2346
2347 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2348 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2349 instead.
2350
2351 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2352 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2353
2354
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002355cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002356 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2357 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2360 yes | no | yes | yes
2361 Arguments :
2362 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2363 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2364 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2365 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2366 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2367 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2368 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2369 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2370 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2371
2372 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2373 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2374 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2375 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2376 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2377 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2378 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2379 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2380 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2381 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2382 "insert" and "prefix".
2383
2384 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002385 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002386
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002387 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002388 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2389 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2390 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2391 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2392 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2393 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2394 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2395 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2396 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2397 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
2399 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2400 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2401 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2402 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2403 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2404 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2405 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2406 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2407 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2408 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002409 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2410 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2411 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002413 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2414 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2415 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002416 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2417 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2418 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2419 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002420 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2421 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2422 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
2424 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2425 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2426 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2427 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2428 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2429 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2430 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2431 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2432 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2433
2434 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2435 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2436 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2437 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2438 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2439 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2440 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2441 persistence cookie in the cache.
2442 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2443
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002444 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2445 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2446 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2447 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2448 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2449 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2450 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2451 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2452 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2453 they logout.
2454
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002455 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2456 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2457 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2458 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2459
2460 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2461 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2462 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2463 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2464 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2465 this attribute.
2466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002467 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002468 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002469 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2470 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2471 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2472 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2473 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2474 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002475
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002476 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2477 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2478 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2479 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2480 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2481 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2482 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2483 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2484 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2485 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2486 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2487 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2488 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2489 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2490 the site.
2491
2492 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2493 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2494 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2495 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2496 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2497 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2498 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2499 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2500 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2501 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2502 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2503 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2504 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2505 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2506 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2507 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002509 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2510 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2511 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2512 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002513
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514 Examples :
2515 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2516 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2517 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002518 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002520 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002521 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002524default-server [param*]
2525 Change default options for a server in a backend
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 yes | no | yes | yes
2528 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002529 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2530 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2531 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2532 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002533
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002534 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002535 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2536
2537 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002540default_backend <backend>
2541 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 yes | yes | yes | no
2544 Arguments :
2545 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2546
2547 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2548 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2549 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2550 will catch all undetermined requests.
2551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552 Example :
2553
2554 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2555 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2556 default_backend dynamic
2557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002558 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002560
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002561description <string>
2562 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2564 no | yes | yes | yes
2565 Arguments : string
2566
2567 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2568 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2569 it describes.
2570 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2571
2572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573disabled
2574 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2576 yes | yes | yes | yes
2577 Arguments : none
2578
2579 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2580 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2581 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2582 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2583 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2584 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2585 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2586
2587 See also : "enabled"
2588
2589
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002590dispatch <address>:<port>
2591 Set a default server address
2592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2593 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002594 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002595
2596 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2597 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2598 during start-up.
2599
2600 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2601 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2602 possible with normal servers.
2603
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002604 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002605 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2606 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2607 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2608 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2609
2610 See also : "server"
2611
2612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613enabled
2614 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 yes | yes | yes | yes
2617 Arguments : none
2618
2619 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2620 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2621
2622 See also : "disabled"
2623
2624
2625errorfile <code> <file>
2626 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | yes | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002631 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2632 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
2634 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002637 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2638 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
2640 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2641 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2642 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2643
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002644 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2645
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2647 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2648 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2649 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2650
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002651 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2652 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2653 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2654 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2655 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2656 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2659 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2660 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002661 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2663
2664 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2665
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002666 Example :
2667 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002668 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002669 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2670 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002672
2673errorloc <code> <url>
2674errorloc302 <code> <url>
2675 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2677 yes | yes | yes | yes
2678 Arguments :
2679 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002680 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681
2682 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2683 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2684 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2685 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2686 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2687
2688 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2689 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2690 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2691
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002692 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2695 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2696 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2697 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2698 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2699 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2700 request.
2701
2702 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2703
2704
2705errorloc303 <code> <url>
2706 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2708 yes | yes | yes | yes
2709 Arguments :
2710 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2711 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2712
2713 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2714 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2715 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2716 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2717 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2718
2719 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2720 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2721 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2722
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002723 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2724
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002725 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2726 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2727 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2728 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002729 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002730
2731 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2732
2733
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002734email-alert from <emailaddr>
2735 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2736 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2738 yes | yes | yes | yes
2739
2740 Arguments :
2741
2742 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2743
2744 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2745 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2746
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002747 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2748 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2749
2750
2751email-alert level <level>
2752 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2753 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2755 yes | yes | yes | yes
2756
2757 Arguments :
2758
2759 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2760 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2761 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2762
2763 By default level is alert
2764
2765 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2766 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2767 for the proxy.
2768
2769 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2770 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002771 section 3.6 about mailers.
2772
2773
2774email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2775 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 yes | yes | yes | yes
2778
2779 Arguments :
2780
2781 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2782
2783 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2784 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002786 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2787 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002788
2789
2790email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2791 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2792 mailers.
2793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | yes | yes | yes
2795
2796 Arguments :
2797
2798 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2799
2800 By default the systems hostname is used.
2801
2802 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2803 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2804 for the proxy.
2805
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002806 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2807 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002808
2809
2810email-alert to <emailaddr>
2811 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2812 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 yes | yes | yes | yes
2815
2816 Arguments :
2817
2818 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2819
2820 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2821 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2822
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002823 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002824 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2825
2826
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002827force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2828 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2830 no | yes | yes | yes
2831
2832 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2833 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2834 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2835 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2836 marked down for maintenance operations.
2837
2838 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2839 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2840 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2841 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2842 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2843 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2844 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2845 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2846 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2847
2848 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2849 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2850 is used.
2851
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002852 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002853 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002854
2855
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002856fullconn <conns>
2857 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2859 yes | no | yes | yes
2860 Arguments :
2861 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2862 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2863
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002864 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002865 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002866 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002867 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2868 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2869 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2870 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2871 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002872 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002873
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002874 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2875 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002876 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2877 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2878 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002880 Example :
2881 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2882 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2883 # connections.
2884 backend dynamic
2885 fullconn 10000
2886 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2887 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2888
2889 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2890
2891
2892grace <time>
2893 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002895 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002896 Arguments :
2897 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2898 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2899 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2900
2901 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2902 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002903 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002904 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2905
2906 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2907 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2908 simplify it.
2909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002911hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002912 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2914 yes | no | yes | yes
2915 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002916 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2917 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002918
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002919 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2920 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2921 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2922 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2923 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2924 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2925 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2926 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2927 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2928 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002929
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002930 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2931 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2932 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2933 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2934 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2935 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2936 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2937 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2938 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2939 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2940 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2941 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2942 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002943 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2944 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002945
2946 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2947
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002948 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002949 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2950 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2951 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002952 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2953 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2954 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002955
2956 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2957 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002958 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2959 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2960 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2961 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2962
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002963 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2964 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2965 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2966 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2967 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2968 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2969 parameter.
2970
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002971 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2972 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2973 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2974 used on strings.
2975
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002976 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2977
2978 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2979 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2980 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2981 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2982 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2983 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2984 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2985 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2986 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2987 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2988 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2989 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002990
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002991 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2992 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2993 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002994
2995 See also : "balance", "server"
2996
2997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998http-check disable-on-404
2999 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003001 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002 Arguments : none
3003
3004 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3005 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3006 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3007 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3008 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3009 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3010 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3011 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003012 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3013 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3014 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3015
3016 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3017
3018
3019http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003020 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003022 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003023 Arguments :
3024 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3025 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003026 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003027 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3028 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3029 details on the supported keywords.
3030
3031 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3032 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3033 with the usual backslash ('\').
3034
3035 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3036 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3037 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3038 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3039 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3040
3041 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003042 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003043 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3044 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3045 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3046
3047 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003049 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3050 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3051 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3052 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3053
3054 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003055 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003056 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3057 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3058 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3059 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3060 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3061 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3062 trace).
3063
3064 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003065 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003066 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3067 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3068 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3069 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3070 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3071 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3072
3073 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3074 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3075 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3076 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3077 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3078 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3079 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3080 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3081
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003082 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3083 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3084 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3085
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003086 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3087 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3088
3089 Examples :
3090 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003091 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003092
3093 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003094 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003095
3096 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003097 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003098
3099 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003100 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003101
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003102 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003103
3104
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003105http-check send-state
3106 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3108 yes | no | yes | yes
3109 Arguments : none
3110
3111 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3112 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3113 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3114 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3115 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3116
3117 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3118 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3119 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3120 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3121 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003122 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3123 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3124 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3125
3126 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3127 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3128 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3129
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003130 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3131 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3132 checked in multiple backends.
3133
3134 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3135 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3136
3137 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3138 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3139 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3140 one fails.
3141
3142 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3143 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3144 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3145
3146 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3147 server's queue.
3148
3149 Example of a header received by the application server :
3150 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3151 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3152
3153 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3154
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003155http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003156 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003157 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003158 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3159 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003160 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3161 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003162 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3163 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3164 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003165 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003166 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3167 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003168 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003170 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3171
3172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3173 no | yes | yes | yes
3174
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003175 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3176 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3177 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3178 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3179 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003180
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003181 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3182 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3183 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3184
3185 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3186 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3187 are evaluated.
3188
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003189 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3190 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3191 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3192 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3193 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3194 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3195 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3196 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3197 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003198 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003199 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3200
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003201 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3202 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3203 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3204 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3205 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3206
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003207 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3208 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3209 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003210 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3211 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003212
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003213 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3214 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3215 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3216 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3217 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3218 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3219 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3220 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3221
3222 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3223 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3224 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003225 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3226 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003227
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003228 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3229 <name>.
3230
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003231 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3232 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3233 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3234 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3235 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3236 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3237 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3238 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3239
3240 Example:
3241
3242 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3243
3244 applied to:
3245
3246 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3247
3248 outputs:
3249
3250 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3251
3252 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3253
3254 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3255 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3256 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3257 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3258 header.
3259
3260 Example:
3261
3262 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3263
3264 applied to:
3265
3266 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3267
3268 outputs:
3269
3270 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3271
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003272 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3273 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3274 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3275 it.
3276
3277 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3278 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3279 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3280 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3281 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3282 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3283
3284 Example :
3285 # prepend the host name before the path
3286 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3287
3288 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3289 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3290 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3291 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3292 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3293 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3294 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3295 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3296
3297 Example :
3298 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3299 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3300
3301 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3302 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3303 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3304 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3305 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3306 "set-query".
3307
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003308 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3309 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3310 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3311 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3312 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3313 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3314 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3315 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3316
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003317 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3318 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3319 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3320 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3321 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3322 another equipment.
3323
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003324 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3325 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3326 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3327 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3328 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3329 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3330 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3331 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3332
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003333 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3334 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3335 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3336 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3337 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3338 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3339 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3340 admin privileges.
3341
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003342 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3343 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3344 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3345 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3346 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3347 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3348 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3349 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3350
3351 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3352 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3353 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3354 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3355 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3356 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3357
3358 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3359 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3360 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3361 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3362 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3363 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3364
3365 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3366 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3367 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3368 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3369 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3370 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3371 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3372 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3373 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3374
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003375 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3376 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3377 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3378 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3379 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3380 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3381 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3382 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3383 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3384 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3385 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3386 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3387
3388 These actions take one or two arguments :
3389 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3390 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3391 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3392 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3393
3394 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3395 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3396 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3397 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3398
3399 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3400 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3401 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3402 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3403 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3404 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3405 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3406 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3407
3408 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3409 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3410 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3411 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3412 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3413
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003414 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3415 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3416 function is documented in the API documentation.
3417
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003418 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3419
3420 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3421 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3422 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3423 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003424
3425 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003426 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3427 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3428 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003429
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003430 http-request allow if nagios
3431 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3432 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3433 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003434
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003435 Example:
3436 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003437 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003438
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003439 Example:
3440 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3441 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3442 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3443 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3444 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3445 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3446 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3447 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3448 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3449
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003450 Example:
3451 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3452 acl add path /addacl
3453 acl del path /delacl
3454
3455 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3456
3457 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3458 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3459
3460 Example:
3461 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3462 acl setmap path /setmap
3463 acl delmap path /delmap
3464
3465 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3466
3467 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3468 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3469
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003470 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3471 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003472
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003473http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003474 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003475 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3476 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003477 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3478 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3479 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3480 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003481 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3482 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003483 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003485 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3486
3487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 no | yes | yes | yes
3489
3490 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3491 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3492 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3493 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3494 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3495 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3496
3497 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3498 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3499 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3500 current section.
3501
3502 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3503 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3504 rules are evaluated.
3505
3506 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3507 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3508 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3509 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3510 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3511 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3512 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3513
3514 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3515 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3516 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3517 external users.
3518
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003519 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3520 <name>.
3521
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003522 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3523 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3524 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3525 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3526 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3527 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3528 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3529 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3530
3531 Example:
3532
3533 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3534
3535 applied to:
3536
3537 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3538
3539 outputs:
3540
3541 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3542
3543 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3544
3545 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3546 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3547 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3548 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3549 header.
3550
3551 Example:
3552
3553 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3554
3555 applied to:
3556
3557 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3558
3559 outputs:
3560
3561 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3562
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003563 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3564 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3565 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3566 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3567 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3568 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3569 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3570 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3571
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003572 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3573 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3574 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3575 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3576 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3577 another equipment.
3578
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003579 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3580 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3581 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3582 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3583 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3584 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3585 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3586 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3587
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003588 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3589 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3590 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3591 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3592 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3593 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3594 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3595 admin privileges.
3596
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003597 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3598 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3599 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3600 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3601 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3602 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3603 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3604 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3605
3606 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3607 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3608 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3609 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3610 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3611 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3612
3613 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3614 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3615 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3616 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3617 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3618 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3619
3620 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3621 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3622 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3623 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3624 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3625 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3626 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3627 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3628 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3629
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003630 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3631 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3632 function is documented in the API documentation.
3633
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003634 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3635
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003636 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003637 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3638 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3639 rules.
3640
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003641 Example:
3642 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3643
3644 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3645
3646 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3647 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3648
3649 Example:
3650 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3651
3652 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3653
3654 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3655 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3656
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003657 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3658 ACL usage.
3659
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003660
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003661http-send-name-header [<header>]
3662 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3663
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | no | yes | yes
3666
3667 Arguments :
3668
3669 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3670
3671 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3672 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3673 is added with the header string proved.
3674
3675 See also : "server"
3676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003677id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003678 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3680 no | yes | yes | yes
3681 Arguments : none
3682
3683 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3684 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3685 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003686
3687
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003688ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3689 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | yes
3692
3693 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3694 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3695 and running).
3696
3697 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3698 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3699 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003700 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003701 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3702
3703 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3704 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3705
3706 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3707 "unless" condition is met.
3708
3709 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3710
3711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003712log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003713log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003714no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003715 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003718
3719 Prefix :
3720 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3721 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3722 prefix does not allow arguments.
3723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003724 Arguments :
3725 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3726 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3727 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3728 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3729 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3730 parameter.
3731
3732 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3733 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3734
3735 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3736 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3737 standard syslog port).
3738
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003739 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3740 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3741 standard syslog port).
3742
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003743 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3744 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3745 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3746 appropriately writeable).
3747
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003748 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3749 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3750 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3751 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3752
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003753 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3754 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3755 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3756 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3757 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3758 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3759 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3760 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3761 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3762 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3763 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3766
3767 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3768 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3769 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3770
3771 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3772 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3773 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003774 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3775 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3776 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3777 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3778 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003779
3780 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3781
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003782 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3783 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3784 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003785
3786 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3787 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3788 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3789 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3790
3791 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3792 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003793
3794 Example :
3795 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003796 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3797 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003798 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3799
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003800
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003801log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003802 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003805
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003806 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3807 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3808 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3809 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3810 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003811
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003812log-tag <string>
3813 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 yes | yes | yes | yes
3816
3817 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3818 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3819 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3820 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3821 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3822 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3823 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3824 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3825 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003827max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3828 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 yes | no | yes | yes
3831
3832 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3833 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3834 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3835 servers.
3836
3837 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3838 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3839 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3840 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3841 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3842 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3843 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3844 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3845 picking a different server.
3846
3847 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3848 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3849 even if they have to be queued.
3850
3851 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3852 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3853
3854
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003855maxconn <conns>
3856 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | yes | yes | no
3859 Arguments :
3860 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3861 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3862 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3863 closes.
3864
3865 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3866 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3867 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3868 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3869 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3870 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3871 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3872 properly tuned.
3873
3874 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3875 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3876 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3877
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003878 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003880 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3881
3882
3883mode { tcp|http|health }
3884 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | yes | yes | yes
3887 Arguments :
3888 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3889 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3890 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3891 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3892
3893 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3894 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3895 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3896 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3897 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3898
3899 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003900 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3901 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3902 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3903 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3904 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3905 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3906 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003907
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003908 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3909 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3910 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003912 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003913 defaults http_instances
3914 mode http
3915
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003916 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003919monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003920 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3922 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 Arguments :
3924 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3925 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003926 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3928 backend and its backup.
3929
3930 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3931 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3932 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3933 servers in a list of backends.
3934
3935 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3936 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3937 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3938 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3939 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3940 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3941 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003942 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3943 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003944
3945 Example:
3946 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003948 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3949 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3950 monitor-uri /site_alive
3951 monitor fail if site_dead
3952
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003953 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
3955
3956monitor-net <source>
3957 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments :
3961 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3962 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3963 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3964 followed by a mask.
3965
3966 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3967 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003968 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003969 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3970
3971 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3972 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3973 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3974 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003975 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3976 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3977 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003979 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3980 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3981 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3982 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3983 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3984 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003986 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3987 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003989 Example :
3990 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3991 frontend www
3992 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3993
3994 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3995
3996
3997monitor-uri <uri>
3998 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4000 yes | yes | yes | no
4001 Arguments :
4002 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4003 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4004
4005 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4006 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4007 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4008 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4009 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4010 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4011 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4012 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4013
4014 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4015 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4016 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4017 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4018 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4019 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4020
4021 Example :
4022 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4023 frontend www
4024 mode http
4025 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4026
4027 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004030option abortonclose
4031no option abortonclose
4032 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | no | yes | yes
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4038 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4039 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4040 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004041 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004042 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4043 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4044 encountered while delivering the response.
4045
4046 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4047 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4048 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4049 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4050 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4051 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004052 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004053 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004054 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004055 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4056 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4057 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4058
4059 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4060 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4061 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4062 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4063 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4064 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4065 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4066 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004067 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004068
4069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4071
4072 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4073
4074
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004075option accept-invalid-http-request
4076no option accept-invalid-http-request
4077 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | yes | yes | no
4080 Arguments : none
4081
4082 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4083 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4084 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4085 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4086 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4087 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4088 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4089 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004090 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4091 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4092 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4093 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4094 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
4095 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004096
4097 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4098 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4099 been confirmed.
4100
4101 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4102 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004103 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4104 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004105 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4106
4107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4109
4110 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4111 stats socket.
4112
4113
4114option accept-invalid-http-response
4115no option accept-invalid-http-response
4116 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | no | yes | yes
4119 Arguments : none
4120
4121 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4122 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4123 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4124 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4125 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4126 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4127 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4128 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
4129 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
4130
4131 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4132 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4133 been confirmed.
4134
4135 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4136 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4137 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4138 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4139
4140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4142
4143 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4144 stats socket.
4145
4146
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004147option allbackups
4148no option allbackups
4149 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4151 yes | no | yes | yes
4152 Arguments : none
4153
4154 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4155 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4156 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4157 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4158 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4159 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4160 order between the backup servers anymore.
4161
4162 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4163 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4164
4165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4167
4168
4169option checkcache
4170no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004171 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 yes | no | yes | yes
4174 Arguments : none
4175
4176 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4177 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004178 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004179 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4180 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004181 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004182
4183 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004184 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004185 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004186 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4187 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004188 to the client are :
4189 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004190 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004191 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004192 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4193 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4194 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4195 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4197 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4198 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4199 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4200 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4202 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4203
4204 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004205 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004206 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004207 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004208 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4209
4210 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4211 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004212 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004213 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4214
4215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4217
4218
4219option clitcpka
4220no option clitcpka
4221 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | yes | yes | no
4224 Arguments : none
4225
4226 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4227 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4228 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4229 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4230
4231 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4232 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4233 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4234 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4235
4236 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4237 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4238 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4239 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4240 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4241
4242 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4243
4244 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4245 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4246 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4247
4248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4250
4251 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4252
4253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004254option contstats
4255 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4257 yes | yes | yes | no
4258 Arguments : none
4259
4260 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4261 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4262 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4263 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4264 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4265 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4266 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4267
4268
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004269option dontlog-normal
4270no option dontlog-normal
4271 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments : none
4275
4276 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4277 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4278 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4279 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4280 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4281 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4282 logged.
4283
4284 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4285 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4286 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004288 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004289 logging.
4290
4291
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004292option dontlognull
4293no option dontlognull
4294 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 yes | yes | yes | no
4297 Arguments : none
4298
4299 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4300 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4301 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4302 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4303 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4304 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4305 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4306
4307 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4308 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4309 would not be logged.
4310
4311 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4312 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004314 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004315
4316
4317option forceclose
4318no option forceclose
4319 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004322 Arguments : none
4323
4324 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4325 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4326 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4327 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4328 global session times in the logs.
4329
4330 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004331 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004332 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004333
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004334 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4335 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4336 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4337
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004338 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4339 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004341 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4342 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4343
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004344 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004345
4346
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004347option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004348 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | yes | yes | yes
4351 Arguments :
4352 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4353 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004354 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004355 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004356
4357 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4358 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4359 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4360 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4361 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4362 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4363 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004364 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4365 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4366 possible that the client has already brought one.
4367
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004368 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004369 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004370 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4371 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004372 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4373 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004374
4375 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4376 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4377 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4378 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4379 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4380 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4381 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4382
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004383 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4384 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4385 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4386 are under the control of the end-user.
4387
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004388 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004389 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4390 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004391 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4392 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4393 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004394
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004395 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004396 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4397 frontend www
4398 mode http
4399 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4400
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004401 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4402 backend www
4403 mode http
4404 option forwardfor header X-Client
4405
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004406 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004407 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004408
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004409
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004410option http-keep-alive
4411no option http-keep-alive
4412 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | yes | yes | yes
4415 Arguments : none
4416
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004417 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4418 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4419 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4420 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4421 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4422 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4423 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4424
4425 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4426 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004427 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4428 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4429 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4430 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4431 situations where this option may be useful :
4432
4433 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4434 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4435
4436 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4437 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4438
4439 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4440 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4441 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4442 request.
4443
4444 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4445 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004446 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4447 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4448 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004449
4450 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4451 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4452
4453 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4454 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4455 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4456 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4457 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4458 not set.
4459
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004460 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4461 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004462 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004463 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004464
4465 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004466 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4467 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004468
4469
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004470option http-no-delay
4471no option http-no-delay
4472 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4474 yes | yes | yes | yes
4475 Arguments : none
4476
4477 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4478 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4479 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4480 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4481 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4482 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4483 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4484 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4485 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4486 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4487 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4488 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4489 affected.
4490
4491 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4492 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4493 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4494 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4495 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4496 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4497 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4498 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4499 latency environments.
4500
4501
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004502option http-pretend-keepalive
4503no option http-pretend-keepalive
4504 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | yes | yes | yes
4507 Arguments : none
4508
4509 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4510 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4511 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4512 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4513 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4514 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4515 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4516 consider the response complete.
4517
4518 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4519 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4520 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4521 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4522 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4523 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4524
4525 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4526 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4527 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4528 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4529 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4530 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4531 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4532
4533 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4534 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004535 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004536 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4537 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004538
4539 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4540 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4541
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004542 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4543 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004544
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004545
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004546option http-server-close
4547no option http-server-close
4548 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | yes | yes | yes
4551 Arguments : none
4552
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004553 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4554 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4555 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4556 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4557 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4558 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4559 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4560 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4561 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4562 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4563 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4564 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4565 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4566 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4567 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4568 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004569
4570 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4571 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4572 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4573 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004574 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4575 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004576
4577 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4578 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004579 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4580 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004581 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4582 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004583
4584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4586
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004587 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004588 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4589 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004590
4591
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004592option http-tunnel
4593no option http-tunnel
4594 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | yes | yes | yes
4597 Arguments : none
4598
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004599 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4600 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4601 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4602 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4603 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4604 "option http-tunnel".
4605
4606 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004607 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004608 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4609 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4610 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4611 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4612 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4613 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4614 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004615
4616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4618
4619 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4620 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4621 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4622
4623
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004624option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004625no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004626 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | yes | yes | no
4629 Arguments : none
4630
4631 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4632 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4633 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4634 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4635 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4636 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4637 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4638
4639 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4640 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4641 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4642 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4643 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4644 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4645 request along its whole life.
4646
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004647 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4648 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4649 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4650 front of an existing proxy.
4651
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004652 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4653
4654 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4655 http-server-close".
4656
4657
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004658option httpchk
4659option httpchk <uri>
4660option httpchk <method> <uri>
4661option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4662 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | no | yes | yes
4665 Arguments :
4666 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4667 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4668 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4669 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4670 ones.
4671
4672 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4673 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4674 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4675
4676 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4677 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4678 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4679 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4680 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4681
4682 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4683 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4684 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4685 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4686 the lack of any response.
4687
4688 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4689
4690 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4691 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4692 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4693
4694 Examples :
4695 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4696 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4697 backend https_relay
4698 mode tcp
4699 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4700 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4701
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004702 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4703 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4704 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004705
4706
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004707option httpclose
4708no option httpclose
4709 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | yes | yes | yes
4712 Arguments : none
4713
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004714 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4715 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4716 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4717 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004718 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004719 "option http-tunnel".
4720
4721 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4722 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4723 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4724 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4725 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4726 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4727 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4728 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004729
4730 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004731 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004732 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4733 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4734 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4735 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4736 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004737
4738 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4739 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004740 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4741 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004742 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4743 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004744
4745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4747
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004748 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4749 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004750
4751
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004752option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004753 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004756 Arguments :
4757 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4758 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4759 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4760 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4761 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004762
4763 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4764 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4765 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4766 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4767 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4768 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4769 ports.
4770
4771 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4772
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004773 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4774 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004776 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004777
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004778
4779option http_proxy
4780no option http_proxy
4781 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4783 yes | yes | yes | yes
4784 Arguments : none
4785
4786 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4787 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4788 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4789 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4790 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4791
4792 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4793 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4794 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4795 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004796 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004797 be analyzed.
4798
4799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4801
4802 Example :
4803 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4804 backend direct_forward
4805 option httpclose
4806 option http_proxy
4807
4808 See also : "option httpclose"
4809
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004810
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004811option independent-streams
4812no option independent-streams
4813 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | yes | yes | yes
4816 Arguments : none
4817
4818 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4819 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4820 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4821 receive data or not.
4822
4823 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4824 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4825 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4826 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4827 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4828 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4829 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4830 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4831 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4832 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4833 socket buffers.
4834
4835 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4836 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4837 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4838 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4839 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4840
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004841 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004842 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4843 deprecated.
4844
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004845 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004846
4847
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004848option ldap-check
4849 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 yes | no | yes | yes
4852 Arguments : none
4853
4854 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4855 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4856 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4857 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4858
4859 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4860 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4861
4862 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4863 configure it.
4864
4865 Example :
4866 option ldap-check
4867
4868 See also : "option httpchk"
4869
4870
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004871option external-check
4872 Use external processes for server health checks
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | no | yes | yes
4875
4876 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4877 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4878 command".
4879
4880 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4881
4882 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4883
4884
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004885option log-health-checks
4886no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004887 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4889 yes | no | yes | yes
4890 Arguments : none
4891
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004892 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4893 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4894 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004895
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004896 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4897 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4898 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4899 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4900 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4901
4902 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4903 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004904
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004905 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4906 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4907 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004908
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004909
4910option log-separate-errors
4911no option log-separate-errors
4912 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | no
4915 Arguments : none
4916
4917 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4918 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4919 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4920 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4921 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4922 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4923 provides very important information.
4924
4925 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4926 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4927 error logs.
4928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004929 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004930 logging.
4931
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004932
4933option logasap
4934no option logasap
4935 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4937 yes | yes | yes | no
4938 Arguments : none
4939
4940 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4941 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4942 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4943 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4944 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4945 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4946 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004947 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004948 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4949 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004951 Examples :
4952 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4953 mode http
4954 option httplog
4955 option logasap
4956 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4957
4958 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4959 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4960 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4961 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004963 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004964 logging.
4965
4966
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004967option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004968 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004971 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004972 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4973 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004974 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004975
4976 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4977 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4978 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4979 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4980 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4981 in the MySQL table, like this :
4982
4983 USE mysql;
4984 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4985 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4986
4987 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4988 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4989 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4990 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4991 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4992 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4993 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4994 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4995 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4996
4997 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4998 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004999
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005000 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005001
5002 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5003 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5004 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5005 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5006 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5007 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5008
5009 See also: "option httpchk"
5010
5011
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005012option nolinger
5013no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005014 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5016 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005017 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005018
5019 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5020 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5021 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5022 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5023 connections.
5024
5025 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5026 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5027 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5028 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5029 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5030 this too.
5031
5032 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5033 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5034 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5035
5036 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5037 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5038 for servers.
5039
5040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5042
5043
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005044option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5045 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | yes | yes | yes
5048 Arguments :
5049 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5050 matching <network>
5051 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5052 header name.
5053
5054 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5055 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5056 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5057 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5058 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5059 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5060 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5061 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5062 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5063 possible that the client has already brought one.
5064
5065 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5066 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5067 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5068 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5069 header and requires different one.
5070
5071 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5072 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5073 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5074 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5075 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5076 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5077 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5078
5079 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5080 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5081 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5082 both are defined.
5083
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005084 Examples :
5085 # Original Destination address
5086 frontend www
5087 mode http
5088 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5089
5090 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5091 backend www
5092 mode http
5093 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5094
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005095 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5096 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005097
5098
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005099option persist
5100no option persist
5101 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005104 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005105
5106 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5107 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5108 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5109 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5110 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5111 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5112 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5113 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5114 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5115 redirected to another valid server.
5116
5117 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5118 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5119
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005120 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005121
5122
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005123option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5124 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | no | yes | yes
5127 Arguments :
5128 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5129 PostgreSQL server.
5130
5131 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5132 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5133 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5134 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5135
5136 See also: "option httpchk"
5137
5138
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005139option prefer-last-server
5140no option prefer-last-server
5141 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5143 yes | no | yes | yes
5144 Arguments : none
5145
5146 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5147 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5148 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5149 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5150 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5151 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5152 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5153 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5154 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005155 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5156 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5157 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5158 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5159 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5160 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5161 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005162
5163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5165
5166 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5167
5168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005169option redispatch
5170no option redispatch
5171 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5173 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005174 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005175
5176 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5177 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5178 be able to access the service anymore.
5179
5180 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5181 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5182
5183 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5184 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5185 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005187 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5188 "redisp" keywords.
5189
5190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5192
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005193 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005194
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005195
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005196option redis-check
5197 Use redis health checks for server testing
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | no | yes | yes
5200 Arguments : none
5201
5202 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5203 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5204 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5205 find the "+PONG" response message.
5206
5207 Example :
5208 option redis-check
5209
5210 See also : "option httpchk"
5211
5212
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005213option smtpchk
5214option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5215 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005219 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5220 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5221 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5222
5223 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5224 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5225 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5226
5227 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5228 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5229 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5230 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5231 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5232 dead server.
5233
5234 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5235 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5236 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5237 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5238
5239 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5240 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5241 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5242 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5243 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5244
5245 Example :
5246 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5247
5248 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005251option socket-stats
5252no option socket-stats
5253
5254 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | yes | yes | no
5257
5258 Arguments : none
5259
5260
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005261option splice-auto
5262no option splice-auto
5263 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5265 yes | yes | yes | yes
5266 Arguments : none
5267
5268 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5269 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5270 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5271 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005272 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005273 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5274 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5275 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5276 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5277
5278 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5279 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5280 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5281 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5282 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5283 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5284 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5285 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5286 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5287 keyword.
5288
5289 Example :
5290 option splice-auto
5291
5292 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5293 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5294
5295 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5296 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5297
5298
5299option splice-request
5300no option splice-request
5301 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | yes | yes | yes
5304 Arguments : none
5305
5306 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005307 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005308 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5309 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5310 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5311 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5312
5313 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5314
5315 Example :
5316 option splice-request
5317
5318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5320
5321 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5322 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5323
5324
5325option splice-response
5326no option splice-response
5327 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | yes | yes | yes
5330 Arguments : none
5331
5332 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005333 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005334 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5335 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5336 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5337 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5338
5339 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5340
5341 Example :
5342 option splice-response
5343
5344 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5345 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5346
5347 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5348 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5349
5350
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005351option srvtcpka
5352no option srvtcpka
5353 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356 Arguments : none
5357
5358 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5359 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5360 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5361 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5362
5363 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5364 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5365 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5366 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5367
5368 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5369 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5370 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5371 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5372 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5373
5374 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5375
5376 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5377 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5378 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5379
5380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5382
5383 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5384
5385
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005386option ssl-hello-chk
5387 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 yes | no | yes | yes
5390 Arguments : none
5391
5392 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5393 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5394 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5395 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5396 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5397 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5398 hello message.
5399
5400 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5401 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5402 messages, which is appreciable.
5403
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005404 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5405 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5406 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005407
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005408 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5409
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005410
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005411option tcp-check
5412 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5414 yes | no | yes | yes
5415
5416 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5417 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5418
5419 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5420 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5421 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5422
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005423 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005424 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5425 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5426 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5427 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5428 only.
5429
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005430 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005431 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5432 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5433 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5434 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5435
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005436 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005437 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5438 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005439 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005440 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5441 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5442 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5443 the respective protocols.
5444 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5445 analysed.
5446
5447 Examples :
5448 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5449 option tcp-check
5450 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5451
5452 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5453 option tcp-check
5454 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5455
5456 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5457 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005458 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005459 option tcp-check
5460 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5461 tcp-check expect +PONG
5462 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5463 tcp-check expect string role:master
5464 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5465 tcp-check expect string +OK
5466
5467 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5468 (send many headers before analyzing)
5469 option tcp-check
5470 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5471 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5472 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5473 tcp-check send \r\n
5474 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5475
5476
5477 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5478
5479
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005480option tcp-smart-accept
5481no option tcp-smart-accept
5482 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | yes | yes | no
5485 Arguments : none
5486
5487 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5488 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5489 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5490 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5491 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5492 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5493
5494 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5495 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5496 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5497 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5498
5499 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5500 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5501 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5502 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5503
5504 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5505 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5506 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5507
5508 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5509 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5510 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5511
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005512 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5513
5514
5515option tcp-smart-connect
5516no option tcp-smart-connect
5517 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | no | yes | yes
5520 Arguments : none
5521
5522 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5523 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5524 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5525 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5526 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5527
5528 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5529 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5530 complex.
5531
5532 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5533 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5534 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5535
5536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5538
5539 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5540
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005541
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005542option tcpka
5543 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5545 yes | yes | yes | yes
5546 Arguments : none
5547
5548 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5549 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5550 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5551 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5552
5553 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5554 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5555 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5556 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5557
5558 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5559 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5560 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5561 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5562 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5563
5564 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5565
5566 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5567 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5568 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5569 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5570 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5571 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5572 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5573 backends.
5574
5575 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5576
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005577
5578option tcplog
5579 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 yes | yes | yes | yes
5582 Arguments : none
5583
5584 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5585 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5586 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5587 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5588 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5589 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5590 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5591 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5592
5593 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005595 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005596
5597
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005598option transparent
5599no option transparent
5600 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005603 Arguments : none
5604
5605 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5606 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5607 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5608 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5609 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5610 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5611 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5612 appropriate server.
5613
5614 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5615 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5616
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005617 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005618 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005619
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005620
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005621external-check command <command>
5622 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625
5626 Arguments :
5627 <command> is the external command to run
5628
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005629 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5630
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005631 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005632
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005633 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5634 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5635 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5636 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5637 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5638 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005639
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005640 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5641
5642 Environment variables :
5643 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5644 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5645
5646 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5647
5648 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5649
5650 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5651 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5652 for a UNIX socket).
5653
5654 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5655
5656 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5657
5658 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5659
5660 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5661
5662 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5663
5664 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5665 socket).
5666
5667 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5668 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5669
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005670 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5671 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5672 failed.
5673
5674 Example :
5675 external-check command /bin/true
5676
5677 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5678
5679
5680external-check path <path>
5681 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | no | yes | yes
5684
5685 Arguments :
5686 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5687
5688 The default path is "".
5689
5690 Example :
5691 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5692
5693 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5694 "external-check command"
5695
5696
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005697persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005698persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005699 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 yes | no | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
5703 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005704 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5705 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005706
5707 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5708 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5709 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5710 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5711 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5712 forwarded to this server.
5713
5714 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5715 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5716 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005717 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005718 a single "listen" section.
5719
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005720 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5721 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5722 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5723
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005724 Example :
5725 listen tse-farm
5726 bind :3389
5727 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5728 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5729 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5730 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5731 persist rdp-cookie
5732 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005733 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005734 balance rdp-cookie
5735 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5736 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5737
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005738 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5739 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005740
5741
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005742rate-limit sessions <rate>
5743 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | yes | yes | no
5746 Arguments :
5747 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5748 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5749
5750 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5751 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5752 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5753 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5754 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5755 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5756
5757 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5758 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5759 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5760 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5761
5762 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5763 listen smtp
5764 mode tcp
5765 bind :25
5766 rate-limit sessions 10
5767 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5768
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005769 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5770 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5771 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005772
5773 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5774
5775
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005776redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5777redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5778redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005779 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 no | yes | yes | yes
5782
5783 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005784 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005785
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005786 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005787 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005788 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5789 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5790 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005791
5792 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5793 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5794 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5795 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5796 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005797 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5798 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5799 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5800 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005801
5802 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5803 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5804 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5805 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5806 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5807 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005808 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005809 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005810 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5811 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5812 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005813
5814 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005815 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5816 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5817 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5818 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5819 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5820 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5821 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5822 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005823
5824 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5825 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5826
5827 - "drop-query"
5828 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5829 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5830 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5831 with a location-type redirect.
5832
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005833 - "append-slash"
5834 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5835 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5836 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5837 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5838
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005839 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5840 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5841 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5842 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5843 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5844 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5845 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5846
5847 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5848 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5849 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5850 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5851 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5852 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5853 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005854
5855 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5856 acl clear dst_port 80
5857 acl secure dst_port 8080
5858 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005859 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005860 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005861 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5862
5863 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005864 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5865 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5866 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005867 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005868
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005869 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5870 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5871 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5872
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005873 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005874 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005875
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005876 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5877 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5878 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005880 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005881
5882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005883redisp (deprecated)
5884redispatch (deprecated)
5885 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005888 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005889
5890 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5891 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5892 be able to access the service anymore.
5893
5894 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5895 redistribute them to a working server.
5896
5897 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5898 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5899 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005901 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5902 "option redispatch" instead.
5903
5904 See also : "option redispatch"
5905
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005906
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005907reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005908 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 no | yes | yes | yes
5911 Arguments :
5912 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5913 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005914 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005915
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005916 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5917 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5918
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005919 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5920 the last header of an HTTP request.
5921
5922 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5923 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5924 responses.
5925
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005926 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5927 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5928 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5929
5930 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5931 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005932
5933
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005934reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5935reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005936 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 no | yes | yes | yes
5939 Arguments :
5940 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5941 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5942 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5943 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5944 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5945 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5946 ignores case.
5947
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005948 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5949 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5950
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005951 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5952 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5953 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5954 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005955 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005956
5957 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5958 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5959
5960 Example :
5961 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5962 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5963 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5964
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005965 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5966 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005967
5968
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005969reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5970reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005971 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 no | yes | yes | yes
5974 Arguments :
5975 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5976 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5977 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5978 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5979 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5980 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5981
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005982 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5983 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5984
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005985 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5986 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5987 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5988 next servers.
5989
5990 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5991 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5992 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5993
5994 Example :
5995 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5996 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5997 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5998
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005999 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6000 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006001
6002
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006003reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6004reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006005 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 no | yes | yes | yes
6008 Arguments :
6009 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6010 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6011 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6012 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6013 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6014 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6015 case.
6016
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006017 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6018 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6019
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006020 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6021 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6022 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6023 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006024 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006025
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006026 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006027 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006028 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006030 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6031 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6032
6033 Example :
6034 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6035 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6036 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6037
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006038 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6039 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006040
6041
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006042reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6043reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006044 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 no | yes | yes | yes
6047 Arguments :
6048 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6049 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6050 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6051 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6052 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6053 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6054 case.
6055
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006056 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6057 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6058
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006059 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6060 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6061 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6062 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6063
6064 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6065 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6066
6067 Example :
6068 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6069 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6070 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6071 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6072
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006073 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6074 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006075
6076
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006077reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6078reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006079 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6081 no | yes | yes | yes
6082 Arguments :
6083 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6084 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6085 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6086 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6087 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6088 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6089
6090 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6091 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6092 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6093 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006094 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006096 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6097 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6098
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006099 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6100 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6101 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6102
6103 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6104 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6105 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6106 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6107 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6108
6109 Example :
6110 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006111 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006112 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6113 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6114
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006115 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6116 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006117
6118
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006119reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6120reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006121 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6123 no | yes | yes | yes
6124 Arguments :
6125 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6126 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6127 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6128 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6129 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6130 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6131 ignores case.
6132
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006133 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6134 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6135
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006136 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6137 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006138 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6139 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6140 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006141 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6142 not set.
6143
6144 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6145 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6146 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6147 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6148 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6149
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006150 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006151 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6152 # block all others.
6153 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6154 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6155
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006156 # block bad guys
6157 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6158 reqitarpit . if badguys
6159
6160 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6161 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006162
6163
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006164retries <value>
6165 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | no | yes | yes
6168 Arguments :
6169 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6170 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6171 default value is 3.
6172
6173 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6174 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6175 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6176
6177 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6178 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6179
6180 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6181 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6182
6183 See also : "option redispatch"
6184
6185
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006186rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006187 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 no | yes | yes | yes
6190 Arguments :
6191 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6192 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006193 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006195 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6196 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6197
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006198 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6199 the last header of an HTTP response.
6200
6201 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6202 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6203 responses.
6204
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006205 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6206 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006207
6208
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006209rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6210rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006211 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 no | yes | yes | yes
6214 Arguments :
6215 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6216 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6217 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6218 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6219 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6220 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6221 ignores case.
6222
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006223 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6224 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6225
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006226 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6227 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006228 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006229 client.
6230
6231 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6232 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6233 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6234
6235 Example :
6236 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006237 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006238
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006239 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6240 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006241
6242
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006243rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6244rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006245 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6247 no | yes | yes | yes
6248 Arguments :
6249 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6250 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6251 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6252 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6253 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6254 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6255 ignores case.
6256
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006257 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6258 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6259
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006260 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6261 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6262 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6263 case-sensitive.
6264
6265 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006266 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6267 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6268 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006269
6270 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6271 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6272
6273 Example :
6274 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6275 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6276
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006277 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6278 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006279
6280
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006281rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6282rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006283 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6285 no | yes | yes | yes
6286 Arguments :
6287 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6288 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6289 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6290 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6291 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6292 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6293 ignores case.
6294
6295 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6296 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6297 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6298 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006299 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006300
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006301 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6302 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6303
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006304 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6305 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6306 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6307
6308 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6309 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6310 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6311 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6312 are not case-sensitive.
6313
6314 Example :
6315 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6316 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6317
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006318 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6319 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006320
6321
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006322server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006323 Declare a server in a backend
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 no | no | yes | yes
6326 Arguments :
6327 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006328 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006329 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006330
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006331 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6332 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6333 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6334 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006335 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6336 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6337 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6338 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6339 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006340 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6341 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6342 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6343 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6344 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6345 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6346 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006347 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006348 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6349 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6350 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6351 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006353 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006354 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6355 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6356 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6357 adding this value to the client's port.
6358
6359 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6360 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006361 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006362
6363 Examples :
6364 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6365 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006366 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006367 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6368 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6369 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006370
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006371 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6372 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006373
6374
6375source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006376source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006377source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006378 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | no | yes | yes
6381 Arguments :
6382 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6383 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006385 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006386 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6387 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6388 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6389 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6390 supported prefixes are :
6391 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6392 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6393 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006394 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006395 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6396 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6397 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6398 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006399
6400 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6401 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006402 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6403 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6404 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006405
6406 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6407 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6408 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6409 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6410 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6411 <addr>.
6412
6413 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6414 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6415 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6416 port.
6417
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006418 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6419 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6420 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6421 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006422 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006423 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6424 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6425 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6426 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6427 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6428 HTTP header.
6429
6430 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6431 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006432 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006433 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6434 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6435 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6436 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6437 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6438 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6439 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6440
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006441 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6442 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6443 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6444 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6445 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6446 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006448 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6449 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6450 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6451 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6452
6453 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6454 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6455 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6456 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6457 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6458 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6459
6460 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6461 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6462 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6463 there are two methods :
6464
6465 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6466 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6467 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6468 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6469 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6470 of the client ranges may be used.
6471
6472 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6473 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6474 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6475 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6476 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6477 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6478 same session.
6479
6480 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6481 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6482 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6483 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6484 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6485 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6486
6487 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6488 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6489 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006490 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006491
6492 Examples :
6493 backend private
6494 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6495 source 192.168.1.200
6496
6497 backend transparent_ssl1
6498 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6499 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6500
6501 backend transparent_ssl2
6502 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6503 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6504 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6505
6506 backend transparent_ssl3
6507 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6508 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6509 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6510
6511 backend transparent_smtp
6512 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6513 # with Tproxy version 4.
6514 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6515
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006516 backend transparent_http
6517 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6518 # proxy.
6519 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006521 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006522 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006524
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006525srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6526 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 yes | no | yes | yes
6529 Arguments :
6530 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6532 as explained at the top of this document.
6533
6534 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6535 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6536 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6537 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6538 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6539 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6540 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6541
6542 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6543 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6544 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6545 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6546 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006547 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006548 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006549 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006550
6551 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6552 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6553 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6554 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6555 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6556 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6557
6558 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6559 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6560
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006561 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6562 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006563
6564
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006565stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6566 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006568 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006569
6570 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6571 matched.
6572
6573 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6574 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6575
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006576 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6577 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6578 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6579
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006580 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6581 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6582 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6583 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006584
6585 Example :
6586 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6587 backend stats_localhost
6588 stats enable
6589 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6590
6591 Example :
6592 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6593 backend stats_auth
6594 stats enable
6595 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6596 stats admin if TRUE
6597
6598 Example :
6599 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6600 userlist stats-auth
6601 group admin users admin
6602 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6603 group readonly users haproxy
6604 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6605
6606 backend stats_auth
6607 stats enable
6608 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6609 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6610 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6611 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6612
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006613 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6614 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6615 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006616
6617
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006618stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6619 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006621 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006622 Arguments :
6623 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6624
6625 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6626
6627 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6628 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6629 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6630 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6631 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6632 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6633
6634 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6635 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6636 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006637 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006638
6639 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6640 report using "stats scope".
6641
6642 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6643 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6644 unobvious parameters.
6645
6646 Example :
6647 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6648 backend public_www
6649 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6650 stats enable
6651 stats hide-version
6652 stats scope .
6653 stats uri /admin?stats
6654 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6655 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6656 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6657
6658 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6659 backend private_monitoring
6660 stats enable
6661 stats uri /admin?stats
6662 stats refresh 5s
6663
6664 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6665
6666
6667stats enable
6668 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006670 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006671 Arguments : none
6672
6673 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6674 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6675 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6676 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6677 - stats auth : no authentication
6678 - stats scope : no restriction
6679
6680 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6681 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6682 unobvious parameters.
6683
6684 Example :
6685 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6686 backend public_www
6687 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6688 stats enable
6689 stats hide-version
6690 stats scope .
6691 stats uri /admin?stats
6692 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6693 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6694 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6695
6696 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6697 backend private_monitoring
6698 stats enable
6699 stats uri /admin?stats
6700 stats refresh 5s
6701
6702 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6703
6704
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006705stats hide-version
6706 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006708 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006709 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006710
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006711 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6712 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6713 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6714 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6715 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6716 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006718 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6719 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6720 unobvious parameters.
6721
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006722 Example :
6723 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6724 backend public_www
6725 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006726 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006727 stats hide-version
6728 stats scope .
6729 stats uri /admin?stats
6730 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6731 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6732 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006733
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006734 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6735 backend private_monitoring
6736 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006737 stats uri /admin?stats
6738 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006739
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006740 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006741
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006742
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006743stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6744 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6745 Access control for statistics
6746
6747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 no | no | yes | yes
6749
6750 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6751 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6752 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6753 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6754 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6755 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6756
6757 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6758 instance.
6759
6760 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6761 about ACL usage.
6762
6763
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006764stats realm <realm>
6765 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006767 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006768 Arguments :
6769 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6770 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6771 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6772
6773 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6774 using a backslash ('\').
6775
6776 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6777 only related to authentication.
6778
6779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6781 unobvious parameters.
6782
6783 Example :
6784 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6785 backend public_www
6786 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6787 stats enable
6788 stats hide-version
6789 stats scope .
6790 stats uri /admin?stats
6791 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6792 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6793 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6794
6795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6796 backend private_monitoring
6797 stats enable
6798 stats uri /admin?stats
6799 stats refresh 5s
6800
6801 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6802
6803
6804stats refresh <delay>
6805 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006808 Arguments :
6809 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6810 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6811 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6812 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6813 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6814 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6815
6816 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6817 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6818 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6819 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6820
6821 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6822 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6823 unobvious parameters.
6824
6825 Example :
6826 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6827 backend public_www
6828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6829 stats enable
6830 stats hide-version
6831 stats scope .
6832 stats uri /admin?stats
6833 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6834 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6835 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6836
6837 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6838 backend private_monitoring
6839 stats enable
6840 stats uri /admin?stats
6841 stats refresh 5s
6842
6843 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6844
6845
6846stats scope { <name> | "." }
6847 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006850 Arguments :
6851 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6852 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6853 section in which the statement appears.
6854
6855 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6856 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6857 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6858 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6859 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6860 exists.
6861
6862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6864 unobvious parameters.
6865
6866 Example :
6867 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6868 backend public_www
6869 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6870 stats enable
6871 stats hide-version
6872 stats scope .
6873 stats uri /admin?stats
6874 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6875 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6876 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6877
6878 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6879 backend private_monitoring
6880 stats enable
6881 stats uri /admin?stats
6882 stats refresh 5s
6883
6884 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6885
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006886
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006887stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006888 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006890 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006891
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006892 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006893 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6894
6895 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6896 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6897
6898 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6899 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006900 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006901
6902 Example :
6903 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6904 backend private_monitoring
6905 stats enable
6906 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6907 stats uri /admin?stats
6908 stats refresh 5s
6909
6910 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6911 global section.
6912
6913
6914stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006915 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | yes | yes | yes
6918 Arguments : none
6919
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006920 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006921 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6922 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6923 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6924 - IP (socket, server)
6925 - cookie (backend, server)
6926
6927 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6928 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006929 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006930
6931 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6932
6933
6934stats show-node [ <name> ]
6935 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006937 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006938 Arguments:
6939 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6940 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6941
6942 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6943 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006944 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006945
6946 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6947 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6948 unobvious parameters.
6949
6950 Example:
6951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6952 backend private_monitoring
6953 stats enable
6954 stats show-node Europe-1
6955 stats uri /admin?stats
6956 stats refresh 5s
6957
6958 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6959 section.
6960
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006961
6962stats uri <prefix>
6963 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006966 Arguments :
6967 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6968 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6969 query string.
6970
6971 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6972 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6973 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6974 possible to reach it in the application.
6975
6976 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006977 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006978 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6979 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6980 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6981 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6982
6983 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6984 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6985 an address or a port to statistics only.
6986
6987 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6988 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6989 unobvious parameters.
6990
6991 Example :
6992 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6993 backend public_www
6994 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6995 stats enable
6996 stats hide-version
6997 stats scope .
6998 stats uri /admin?stats
6999 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7000 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7001 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7002
7003 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7004 backend private_monitoring
7005 stats enable
7006 stats uri /admin?stats
7007 stats refresh 5s
7008
7009 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7010
7011
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007012stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7013 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007015 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007016
7017 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007018 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007019 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7020 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7021 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7022
7023 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7024 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7025 the "stick-table" statement.
7026
7027 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7028 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7029 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7030 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7031 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7032
7033 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7034 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7035 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7036 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7037 transformation rules.
7038
7039 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7040 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7041 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7042 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7043 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7044 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7045 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7046
7047 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7048 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7049 ACL based conditions.
7050
7051 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7052 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7053 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7054 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7055
7056 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7057 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7058 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7059 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7060
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007061 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7062 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7063 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7064
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007065 Example :
7066 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7067 # last 30 minutes
7068 backend pop
7069 mode tcp
7070 balance roundrobin
7071 stick store-request src
7072 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7073 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7074 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7075
7076 backend smtp
7077 mode tcp
7078 balance roundrobin
7079 stick match src table pop
7080 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7081 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7082
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007083 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007084 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007085
7086
7087stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7088 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 no | no | yes | yes
7091
7092 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7093 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7094 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7095 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7096
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007097 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7098 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7099 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7100
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007101 Examples :
7102 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007103 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007104
7105 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7106 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7107 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7108
7109
7110 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7111 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7112 backend http
7113 mode http
7114 balance roundrobin
7115 stick on src table https
7116 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7117 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7118 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7119
7120 backend https
7121 mode tcp
7122 balance roundrobin
7123 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7124 stick on src
7125 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7126 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7127
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007128 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007129
7130
7131stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7132 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7134 no | no | yes | yes
7135
7136 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007137 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007138 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7139 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7140 server is selected.
7141
7142 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7143 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7144 the "stick-table" statement.
7145
7146 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7147 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7148 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7149 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7150 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7151 address.
7152
7153 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7154 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7155 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7156 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7157 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7158 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7159 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7160 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7161 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7162 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7163
7164 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7165 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7166 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7167 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7168 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7169 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7170 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7171
7172 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7173 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7174 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7175 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7176
7177 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7178 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7179 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7180 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7181 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7182 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007183 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7184 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7185 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7186 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7187 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7188 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007189
7190 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7191 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7192 the request.
7193
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007194 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7195 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7196 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7197
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007198 Example :
7199 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7200 # last 30 minutes
7201 backend pop
7202 mode tcp
7203 balance roundrobin
7204 stick store-request src
7205 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7206 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7207 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7208
7209 backend smtp
7210 mode tcp
7211 balance roundrobin
7212 stick match src table pop
7213 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7214 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7215
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007216 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007217 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007218
7219
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007220stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007221 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7222 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007223 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007225 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007226
7227 Arguments :
7228 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7229 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7230 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7231 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7232
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007233 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7234 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7235 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7236 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7237
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007238 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7239 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7240 instance.
7241
7242 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7243 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7244 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7245 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7246 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7247 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007248 to 32 characters.
7249
7250 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7251 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7252 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007253 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007254 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7255 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007256
7257 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007258 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7259 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007260 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7261 increase.
7262
7263 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007264 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7265 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7266 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007267
7268 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7269 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7270 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7271 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7272 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7273 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7274 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7275 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7276 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7277 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7278 parameter (see below).
7279
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007280 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7281 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7282 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7283 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7284 soft restart.
7285
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007286 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7287
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007288 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7289 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7290 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7291 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7292 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007293 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007294 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7295 if not expiration delay is specified.
7296
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007297 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7298 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7299 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7300 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007301 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7302 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7303 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7304 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7305 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7306 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7307 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7308 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7309 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7310 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7311 types and their arguments.
7312
7313 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7314 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7315 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7316 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7317
7318 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7319 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7320 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7321 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7322
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007323 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7324 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7325 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7326 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7327 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7328 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7329
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007330 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7331 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7332 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7333 they were received.
7334
7335 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7336 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7337 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7338 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7339 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7340
7341 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7342 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7343 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7344 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7345 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7346
7347 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7348 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7349 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7350
7351 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7352 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7353 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7354 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7355 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7356
7357 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7358 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7359 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7360 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7361 the client side.
7362
7363 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7364 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7365 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7366 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7367 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7368 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7369 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7370
7371 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7372 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7373 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7374 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7375 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7376 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7377 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7378
7379 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7380 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7381 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7382 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7383 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7384 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7385
7386 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7387 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7388 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7389 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7390
7391 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7392 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7393 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7394 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7395 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7396 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7397 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7398 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7399 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7400 recommended for better fairness.
7401
7402 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7403 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7404 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7405 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7406
7407 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7408 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7409 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7410 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7411 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7412 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7413 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7414 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7415 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7416 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007417
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007418 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7419 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007420 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7421 reference it.
7422
7423 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7424 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7425 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7426 as an exclusive stickiness.
7427
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007428 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7429 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7430 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7431 something that can be ignored.
7432
7433 Example:
7434 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7435 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7436 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7437 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7438
7439 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007440 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007441
7442
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007443stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7444 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7446 no | no | yes | yes
7447
7448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007449 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007450 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7451 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7452 server is selected.
7453
7454 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7455 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7456 the "stick-table" statement.
7457
7458 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7459 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7460 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7461 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7462
7463 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7464 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7465 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7466 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7467 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7468 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007469 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007470 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7471 rules.
7472
7473 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7474 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7475 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7476 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7477 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7478 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7479 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7480
7481 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7482 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7483 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7484 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7485
7486 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7487 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7488 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7489 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7490 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7491 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007492 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7493 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7494 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7495 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7496 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7497 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7498 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7499 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7500 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007501
7502 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7503
7504 Example :
7505 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7506 backend https
7507 mode tcp
7508 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007509 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007510 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007511
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007512 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7513 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7514
7515 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7516 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7517 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7518
7519 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7520 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007521
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007522 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7523 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7524 # at offset 44.
7525
7526 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7527 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7528
7529 # Learn on response if server hello.
7530 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007531
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007532 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7533 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7534
7535 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7536 extraction.
7537
7538
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007539tcp-check connect [params*]
7540 Opens a new connection
7541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 no | no | yes | yes
7543
7544 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7545 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7546 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7547
7548 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7549 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7550 of the sequence.
7551
7552 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7553 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7554 do.
7555
7556 Parameters :
7557 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7558 use the TCP connection.
7559
7560 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7561 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7562 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7563
7564 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7565
7566 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7567
7568 Examples:
7569 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7570 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7571 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7572 option tcp-check
7573 tcp-check connect
7574 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7575 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7576 tcp-check send \r\n
7577 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7578 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7579 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7580 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7581 tcp-check send \r\n
7582 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7583 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7584
7585 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7586 option tcp-check
7587 tcp-check connect port 110
7588 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7589 tcp-check connect port 143
7590 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7591 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7592
7593 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7594
7595
7596tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7597 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 no | no | yes | yes
7600
7601 Arguments :
7602 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7603 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7604 binary.
7605 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7606 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7607 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7608
7609 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7610 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7611 with the usual backslash ('\').
7612 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7613 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7614 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7615 used upper or lower case.
7616
7617
7618 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7619
7620 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7621 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7622 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7623 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7624 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7625 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7626 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7627 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7628
7629 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7631 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7632 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7633 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7634 expression.
7635
7636 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7637 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7638 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7639 this exact hexadecimal string.
7640 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7641
7642 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7643 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7644 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7645 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7646 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7647 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7648 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7649 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7650 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7651 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7652 the null character.
7653
7654 Examples :
7655 # perform a POP check
7656 option tcp-check
7657 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7658
7659 # perform an IMAP check
7660 option tcp-check
7661 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7662
7663 # look for the redis master server
7664 option tcp-check
7665 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7666 tcp-check expect +PONG
7667 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7668 tcp-check expect string role:master
7669 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7670 tcp-check expect string +OK
7671
7672
7673 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7674 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7675
7676
7677tcp-check send <data>
7678 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7680 no | no | yes | yes
7681
7682 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7683 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7684
7685 Examples :
7686 # look for the redis master server
7687 option tcp-check
7688 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7689 tcp-check expect string role:master
7690
7691 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7692 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7693
7694
7695tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7696 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7697 tcp health check
7698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 no | no | yes | yes
7700
7701 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7702 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7703 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7704 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7705 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7706 hexadecimal string.
7707 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7708
7709 Examples :
7710 # redis check in binary
7711 option tcp-check
7712 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7713 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7714
7715
7716 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7717 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7718
7719
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007720tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7721 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007724 Arguments :
7725 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007726 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7727 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007729 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007730
7731 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7732 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007733 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7734 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7735 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7736 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7737 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7738 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007740 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7741 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7742 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7743 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007744
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007745 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007746 - accept :
7747 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7748 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7749 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007750
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007751 - reject :
7752 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7753 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7754 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7755 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7756 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7757 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7758 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7759 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7760 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7761 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7762 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7763 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007764
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007765 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7766 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7767 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7768 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7769 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7770 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7771 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7772 hosts.
7773
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007774 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7775 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7776 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7777 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7778 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7779 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7780 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7781 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7782 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7783 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7784 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7785
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007786 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007787 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007788 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007789 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007790 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7791 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007792 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007793 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7794 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7795 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7796 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7797 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007798
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007799 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007800 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007801 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007802 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7803 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7804 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7805 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007807 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7808 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7809 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7810 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007812 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7813 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7814 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7815 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7816 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007817 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7818 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7819 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7820 layer7 information is extracted.
7821
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007822 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7823 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7824 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7825 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7826 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007828 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7829 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7830 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007832 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7833 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7834 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007836 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007837 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007838 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007840 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7841 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7842 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007844 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007845 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7846 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007847
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007848 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7849
7850 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7851
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007852 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007854 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007855
7856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007857tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7858 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007860 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007861 Arguments :
7862 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007863 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007864 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7865 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007866
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007867 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007869 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7870 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7871 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7872 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7873 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007875 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7876 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7877 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7878 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007879 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7880 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7881 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7882 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7883 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7884 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007885 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007886 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7889 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7890 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7891 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007892
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007893 Four types of actions are supported :
7894 - accept : the request is accepted
7895 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7896 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007897 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007899 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7900 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007901
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007902 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7903 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7904 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7905 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7906 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7907 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007909 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007910 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7911 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007914 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7915 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7916 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7917 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007918 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7919 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7920 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007921
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007922 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007923 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7924 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7925 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007926
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007927 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
7928 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
7929 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
7930 documentation.
7931
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007932 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007933 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7934 # and reject everything else.
7935 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7936 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007937 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007938 tcp-request content reject
7939
7940 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007941 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7942 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7943 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007944 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007945
7946 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7947 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7948 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007949 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007950 tcp-request content reject
7951
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007952 Example:
7953 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7954 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007955 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007956
7957 Example:
7958 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7959 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007960 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007962 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7963 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7964
7965 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007966 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007967 # protecting all our sites
7968 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007969 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7970 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007971 ...
7972 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7973
7974 backend http_dynamic
7975 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007976 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007977 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007978 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7979 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7980 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007981 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007983 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007985 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007986
7987
7988tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7989 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007991 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007992 Arguments :
7993 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7994 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7995 as explained at the top of this document.
7996
7997 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7998 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7999 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8000 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8001 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8002
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008003 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8004 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8005 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8006 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8007
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008008 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8009 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008010 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008011 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008012 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8013 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8014 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8015 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008016
8017 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8018 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8019 it pass through unaffected.
8020
8021 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8022 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8023 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008024 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008025 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8026 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008027 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8028 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8029 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008030
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008031 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008032 "timeout client".
8033
8034
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008035tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8036 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 no | no | yes | yes
8039 Arguments :
8040 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008041 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008042
8043 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8044
8045 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8046 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8047 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008048 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8049 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008050
8051 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8052
8053 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8054 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8055 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8056 inserted.
8057
8058 Two types of actions are supported :
8059 - accept :
8060 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8061 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8062 the rules evaluation.
8063
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008064 - close :
8065 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8066 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8067 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8068 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8069 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8070 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008071 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008072 protocols.
8073
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008074 - reject :
8075 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8076 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008077 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008078
8079 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8080 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8081 for changing the default action to a reject.
8082
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008083 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8084 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8085 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8086 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008087 period.
8088
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008089 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8090 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8091 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8092 documentation.
8093
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008094 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8095
8096 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8097
8098
8099tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8100 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8102 no | no | yes | yes
8103 Arguments :
8104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8106 as explained at the top of this document.
8107
8108 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8109
8110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008111timeout check <timeout>
8112 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8113 established.
8114
8115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8116 yes | no | yes | yes
8117 Arguments:
8118 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8119 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8120 as explained at the top of this document.
8121
8122 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8123 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8124 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8125 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008126 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8127 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8128 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008129
8130 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8131 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8132
8133 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8134 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008135 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008136
8137 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8138 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8139 forget about it.
8140
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008141 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8142 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008143
8144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008145timeout client <timeout>
8146timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8147 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 yes | yes | yes | no
8150 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8153 as explained at the top of this document.
8154
8155 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8156 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8157 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8158 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8159 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8160 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8161 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8162 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008163 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008164 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008165 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8166 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008167 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8168 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008169
8170 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8171 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8172 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8173 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8174 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8175 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8176
8177 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8178 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8179 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8180
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008181 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008182
8183
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008184timeout client-fin <timeout>
8185 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 yes | yes | yes | no
8188 Arguments :
8189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8191 as explained at the top of this document.
8192
8193 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8194 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8195 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8196 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8197 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8198 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8199 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8200 down in one direction.
8201
8202 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8203 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8204 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8205
8206 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8207
8208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008209timeout connect <timeout>
8210timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8211 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8213 yes | no | yes | yes
8214 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008215 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008216 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8217 as explained at the top of this document.
8218
8219 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008220 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008221 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008222 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008223 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8224 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008225
8226 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8232
8233 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8234 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8235 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8236
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008237 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8238 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008239
8240
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008241timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8242 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 yes | yes | yes | yes
8245 Arguments :
8246 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8247 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8248 as explained at the top of this document.
8249
8250 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8251 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8252 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8253 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8254 once the request has started to present itself.
8255
8256 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8257 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8258 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8259 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8260 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8261
8262 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8263 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8264 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8265 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8266
8267 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8268 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8269 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8270 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8271 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008272 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008273
8274 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8275 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8276 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8277 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8278
8279 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8280
8281
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008282timeout http-request <timeout>
8283 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008285 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8289 as explained at the top of this document.
8290
8291 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8292 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8293 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8294 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8295 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8296 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8297 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008298 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8299 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8300 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8301 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8302 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8303 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8304 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008305
8306 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8307 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008308 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8309 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008310
8311 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8312 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8313 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8314 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8315 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8316
8317 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008318 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8319 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8320 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008321
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008322 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008323
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008324
8325timeout queue <timeout>
8326 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 yes | no | yes | yes
8329 Arguments :
8330 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8331 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8332 as explained at the top of this document.
8333
8334 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8335 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8336 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8337 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8338 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8339
8340 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8341 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8342 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8343 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8344
8345 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8346
8347
8348timeout server <timeout>
8349timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8350 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8352 yes | no | yes | yes
8353 Arguments :
8354 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8355 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8356 as explained at the top of this document.
8357
8358 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8359 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8360 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8361 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8362 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8363 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8364 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8365
8366 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8367 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8368 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8369 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8370 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008371 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008372 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008373 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8374 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8375 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8376 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008377
8378 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8379 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8380 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8381 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8382 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8383 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8384
8385 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8386 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8387 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8388
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008389 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008390
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008391
8392timeout server-fin <timeout>
8393 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | no | yes | yes
8396 Arguments :
8397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8399 as explained at the top of this document.
8400
8401 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8402 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8403 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8404 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8405 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8406 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8407 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8408 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8409 situations, it should not be needed.
8410
8411 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8412 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8413 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8414
8415 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8416
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008417
8418timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008419 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 yes | yes | yes | yes
8422 Arguments :
8423 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8424 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8425 as explained at the top of this document.
8426
8427 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8428 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8429 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8430
8431 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8432 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8433 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8434 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008435 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008436
8437 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8438
8439
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008440timeout tunnel <timeout>
8441 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8443 yes | no | yes | yes
8444 Arguments :
8445 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8446 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8447 as explained at the top of this document.
8448
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008449 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008450 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8451 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8452 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8453 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8454 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8455 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8456 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8457 specified.
8458
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008459 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8460 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8461 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8462 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8463 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8464 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8465 state.
8466
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008467 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8468 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8469 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8470 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8471 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8472
8473 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8474 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8475 forget about it.
8476
8477 Example :
8478 defaults http
8479 option http-server-close
8480 timeout connect 5s
8481 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008482 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008483 timeout server 30s
8484 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8485
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008486 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008487
8488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008489transparent (deprecated)
8490 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008492 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008493 Arguments : none
8494
8495 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8496 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8497 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8498 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8499 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8500 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8501 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8502 appropriate server.
8503
8504 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8505
8506 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8507 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8508
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008509 See also: "option transparent"
8510
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008511unique-id-format <string>
8512 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 yes | yes | yes | no
8515 Arguments :
8516 <string> is a log-format string.
8517
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008518 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8519 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8520 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8521 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008523 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8524 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8525 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8526 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8527 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8528 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8529 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8530 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008532 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8533 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008535 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008536
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008537 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008538
8539 will generate:
8540
8541 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8542
8543 See also: "unique-id-header"
8544
8545unique-id-header <name>
8546 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 yes | yes | yes | no
8549 Arguments :
8550 <name> is the name of the header.
8551
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008552 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8553 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008555 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008556
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008557 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008558 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8559
8560 will generate:
8561
8562 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8563
8564 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008565
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008566use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008567 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8569 no | yes | yes | no
8570 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008571 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8572 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008573
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008574 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8575 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008576
8577 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8578 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8579 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008580 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8581 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8582 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8583 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008584
8585 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8586 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8587 assign the backend.
8588
8589 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8590 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8591 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8592 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8593 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8594 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8595
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008596 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008597 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008598 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8599 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8600 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8601
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008602 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8603 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8604 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8605 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8606 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8607 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8608 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8609 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8610 cannot be forced from the request.
8611
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008612 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008613 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8614 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8615
8616 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8617 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008618
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008619
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008620use-server <server> if <condition>
8621use-server <server> unless <condition>
8622 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8624 no | no | yes | yes
8625 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008626 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008627
8628 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8629
8630 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8631 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8632 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8633
8634 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8635 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8636 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8637 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8638 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8639 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8640 matches will assign the server.
8641
8642 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8643 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8644 with the next rules until one matches.
8645
8646 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8647 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8648 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8649 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8650
8651 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8652 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8653 stripped.
8654
8655 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8656 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8657 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8658 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8659
8660 Example :
8661 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8662 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8663 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8664 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8665 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8666 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8667 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8668 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8669 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8670
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008671 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008673
86745. Bind and Server options
8675--------------------------
8676
8677The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8678depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8679settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8680written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8681described in this section.
8682
8683
86845.1. Bind options
8685-----------------
8686
8687The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8688as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8689no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8690parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8691while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8692provided immediately after the setting name.
8693
8694The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8695
8696accept-proxy
8697 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008698 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8699 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008700 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8701 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8702 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8703 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8704 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8705 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8706 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008707 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8708 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008709
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008710alpn <protocols>
8711 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8712 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8713 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8714 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8715 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8716 initial NPN extension.
8717
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008718backlog <backlog>
8719 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8720 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8721
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008722ecdhe <named curve>
8723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008724 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8725 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008726
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008727ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8729 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8730 client's certificate.
8731
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008732ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8734 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8735 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8736 error is ignored.
8737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008738ciphers <ciphers>
8739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8740 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008741 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008742 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8743 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8744
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008745crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8747 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8748 to verify client's certificate.
8749
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008750crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8752 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8753 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8754 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8755 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8756 file.
8757
8758 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8759 are loaded.
8760
8761 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008762 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008763 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8764 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8765 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8766 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8767 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8768 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8769 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008770
8771 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8772 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8773 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8774 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008775 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8776 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008777
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008778 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008779
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008780 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8781 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008782 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008783 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8784 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8785 clients).
8786
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008787 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8788 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8789 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8790 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8791 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8792 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8793 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8794 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8795 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8796 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8797 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8798 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8799 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8800
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008801 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8802 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
8803 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
8804 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
8805 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
8806
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008807crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8809 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008810 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008811 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008812
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008813crt-list <file>
8814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008815 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8816 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008817
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008818 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008819
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008820 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8821 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8822 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8823 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8824 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8825 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8826 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8827 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008829defer-accept
8830 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8831 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8832 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8833 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8834 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8835 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8836 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8837 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8838 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8839 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8840 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8841
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008842force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008843 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008844 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008845 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8846 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008847
8848force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008849 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008850 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8851 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008852
8853force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008854 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008855 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8856 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008857
8858force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008859 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008860 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8861 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008862
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008863gid <gid>
8864 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8865 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8866 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8867 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8868 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8869
8870group <group>
8871 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8872 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8873 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8874 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8875 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8876
8877id <id>
8878 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8879 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8880 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8881 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8882
8883interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008884 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8885 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8886 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8887 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8888 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8889 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8890 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008891
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008892level <level>
8893 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8894 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8895 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8896 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8897 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8898 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8899 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8900 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8901 counters).
8902 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8903 all counters).
8904
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008905maxconn <maxconn>
8906 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8907 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8908 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8909 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8910 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8911 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8912 eat all memory.
8913
8914mode <mode>
8915 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8916 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8917 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8918 UNIX sockets.
8919
8920mss <maxseg>
8921 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8922 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8923 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8924 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8925 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8926 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8927 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8928 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8929 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8930 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8931 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8932
8933name <name>
8934 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8935 page.
8936
8937nice <nice>
8938 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8939 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8940 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8941 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8942 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8943 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8944 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8945 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8946 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8947 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8948 one for an RDP socket.
8949
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008950no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008952 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008953 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008954 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8955 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008956 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008957
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008958no-tls-tickets
8959 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8960 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8961 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008962 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8963 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008964
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008965no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008967 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008968 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008969 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8970 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8971 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008972
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008973no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008975 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008976 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008977 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8978 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8979 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008980
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008981no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008982 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008983 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008984 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008985 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8986 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8987 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008988
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008989npn <protocols>
8990 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8991 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8992 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8993 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008994 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8995 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008996
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008997process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8998 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8999 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9000 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9001 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9002 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9003 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9004 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009005 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9006 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9007 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9008 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9009 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9010 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9011 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009013ssl
9014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009015 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009016 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9017 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9018 to deciphered contents.
9019
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009020strict-sni
9021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9022 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9023 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9024 See the "crt" option for more information.
9025
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009026tcp-ut <delay>
9027 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9028 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9029 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9030 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9031 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9032 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9033 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9034 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9035 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9036 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9037 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9038
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009039tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009040 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009041 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9042 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9043 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9044 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9045 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9046 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9047 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009048 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9049 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9050 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009051
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009052tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9053 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9054 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9055 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9056 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9057 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9058 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9059 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9060 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9061 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9062 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009064transparent
9065 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9066 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9067 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9068 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9069 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9070 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9071 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9072 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9073 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9074 so check for support with your vendor.
9075
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009076v4v6
9077 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9078 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9079 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9080 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009081 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009082
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009083v6only
9084 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9085 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9086 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009087 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9088 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009090uid <uid>
9091 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9092 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9093 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9094 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9095 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9096
9097user <user>
9098 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9099 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9100 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9101 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9102 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9103
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009104verify [none|optional|required]
9105 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9106 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9107 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9108 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9109 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009110 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9111 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9112 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9113 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009114
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020091155.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009116------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009118The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9119which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9120arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9121settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9122after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9123Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9124address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009126 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009127 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009129The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009130
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009131addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009132 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9133 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9134 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9135 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9136 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009138 Supported in default-server: No
9139
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009140agent-check
9141 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009142 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9143 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9144 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9145 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009146
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009147 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009148 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009149 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9150 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9151 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009152
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009153 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9154 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009155
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009156 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9157 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9158 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009159
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009160 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9161 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9162 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009163
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009164 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9165 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9166 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9167 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9168 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9169 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9170 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009171
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009172 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9173 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009174
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009175 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9176 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9177 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9178 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9179 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9180 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9181 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9182 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9183 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009184
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009185 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9186 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009187 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9188 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9189 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9190 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009191
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009192 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9193 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009194
9195 Supported in default-server: No
9196
9197agent-inter <delay>
9198 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9199 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9200
9201 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9202 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9203 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9204 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9205 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9206 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9207 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9208 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9209 of backends use the same servers.
9210
9211 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9212
9213 Supported in default-server: Yes
9214
9215agent-port <port>
9216 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9217
9218 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9219
9220 Supported in default-server: Yes
9221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009222backup
9223 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9224 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9225 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9226 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9227 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9228 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009230 Supported in default-server: No
9231
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009232ca-file <cafile>
9233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9234 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9235 server's certificate.
9236
9237 Supported in default-server: No
9238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009239check
9240 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009241 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9242 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9243 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9244 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9245 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9246 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9247 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009248 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9249 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9250 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009252 Supported in default-server: No
9253
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009254check-send-proxy
9255 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9256 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9257 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9258 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9259 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9260 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9261 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9262
9263 Supported in default-server: No
9264
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009265check-ssl
9266 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9267 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9268 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9269 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009270 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009271 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9272 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9273 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9274 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9275
9276 Supported in default-server: No
9277
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009278ciphers <ciphers>
9279 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009280 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009281 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9282 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9283 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9284 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9285 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9286 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9287
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009288 Supported in default-server: No
9289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009290cookie <value>
9291 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9292 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9293 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9294 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9295 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9296 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9297 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009299 Supported in default-server: No
9300
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009301crl-file <crlfile>
9302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9303 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9304 to verify server's certificate.
9305
9306 Supported in default-server: No
9307
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009308crt <cert>
9309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9310 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9311 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9312 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9313 certificate request.
9314
9315 Supported in default-server: No
9316
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009317disabled
9318 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9319 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9320 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9321 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9322 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9323
9324 Supported in default-server: No
9325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009326error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009327 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9328 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9329 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009331 Supported in default-server: Yes
9332
9333 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009335fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009336 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9337 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9338 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009340 Supported in default-server: Yes
9341
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009342force-sslv3
9343 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9344 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009345 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9346 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009347
9348 Supported in default-server: No
9349
9350force-tlsv10
9351 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009352 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9353 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009354
9355 Supported in default-server: No
9356
9357force-tlsv11
9358 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009359 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9360 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009361
9362 Supported in default-server: No
9363
9364force-tlsv12
9365 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009366 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9367 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009368
9369 Supported in default-server: No
9370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009371id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009372 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9373 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9374 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009376 Supported in default-server: No
9377
9378inter <delay>
9379fastinter <delay>
9380downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009381 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9382 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9383 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9384 between checks depending on the server state :
9385
9386 Server state | Interval used
9387 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9388 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9389 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9390 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9391 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9392 or yet unchecked. |
9393 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9394 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9395 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9398 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9399 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9400 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009401 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9402 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9403 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9404 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9405 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009407 Supported in default-server: Yes
9408
9409maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9411 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9412 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9413 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9414 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9415 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9416 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9417 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009419 Supported in default-server: Yes
9420
9421maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009422 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9423 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9424 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9425 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9426 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9427 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9428 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009430 Supported in default-server: Yes
9431
9432minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9434 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9435 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9436 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9437 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9438 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009439 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009440 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009442 Supported in default-server: Yes
9443
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009444no-ssl-reuse
9445 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9446 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9447 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9448 and for paranoid users.
9449
9450 Supported in default-server: No
9451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009452no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009453 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9454 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009455 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009456
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009457 Supported in default-server: No
9458
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009459no-tls-tickets
9460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9461 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9462 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009463 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9464 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009465
9466 Supported in default-server: No
9467
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009468no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009469 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009470 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9471 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009472 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9473 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9474 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009475
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009476 Supported in default-server: No
9477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009478no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009479 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009480 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9481 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009482 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9483 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9484 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009485
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009486 Supported in default-server: No
9487
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009488no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009489 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009490 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9491 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009492 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9493 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9494 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009495
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009496 Supported in default-server: No
9497
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009498non-stick
9499 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9500 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9501 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9502
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009503 Supported in default-server: No
9504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009505observe <mode>
9506 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9507 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9508 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9509 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9510 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9511 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009512 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009514 Supported in default-server: No
9515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009516 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009518on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009519 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9520 Currently, four modes are available:
9521 - fastinter: force fastinter
9522 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9523 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9524 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9525 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009527 Supported in default-server: Yes
9528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009529 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9530
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009531on-marked-down <action>
9532 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9533 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009534 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9535 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9536 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9537 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9538 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9539 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9540 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9541 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009542
9543 Actions are disabled by default
9544
9545 Supported in default-server: Yes
9546
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009547on-marked-up <action>
9548 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9549 Currently one action is available:
9550 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9551 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9552 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9553 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9554 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9555 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9556 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9557 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9558
9559 Actions are disabled by default
9560
9561 Supported in default-server: Yes
9562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009563port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009564 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9565 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9566 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9567 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9568 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9569 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009571 Supported in default-server: Yes
9572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009573redir <prefix>
9574 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9575 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9576 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9577 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9578 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9579 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9580 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9581 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009582 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9584 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9585 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9586 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9587 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9588
9589 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009591 Supported in default-server: No
9592
9593rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009594 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9595 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9596 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009598 Supported in default-server: Yes
9599
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009600send-proxy
9601 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9602 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9603 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9604 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9605 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9606 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9607 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9608 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9609 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009610 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9611 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9612 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9613 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9614 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009615
9616 Supported in default-server: No
9617
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009618send-proxy-v2
9619 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9620 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9621 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9622 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9623 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9624 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9625 option of the "bind" keyword.
9626
9627 Supported in default-server: No
9628
9629send-proxy-v2-ssl
9630 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9631 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9632 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9633 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9634 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9635 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9636 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9637 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9638
9639 Supported in default-server: No
9640
9641send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9642 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9643 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9644 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9645 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9646 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9647 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9648 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9649 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9650 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9651
9652 Supported in default-server: No
9653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009654slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009655 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9656 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9657 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9658 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9659 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9660 parameters :
9661
9662 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9663 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9664
9665 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9666 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9667 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9668 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9669
9670 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9671 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9672 seen as failed.
9673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009674 Supported in default-server: Yes
9675
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009676source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009678source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009679 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9680 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9681 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9682 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9683
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009684 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9685 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9686 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9687 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9688 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9689 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9690 server.
9691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009692 Supported in default-server: No
9693
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009694ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009695 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9696 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9697 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9698 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9699 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9700 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009701 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009702
9703 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009705track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009706 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9707 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9708 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9709 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009710 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009712 Supported in default-server: No
9713
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009714verify [none|required]
9715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009716 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9717 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9718 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9719 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009720 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9721 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9722 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009723
9724 Supported in default-server: No
9725
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009726verifyhost <hostname>
9727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9728 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9729 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9730 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9731 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9732 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9733
9734 Supported in default-server: No
9735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009736weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009737 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9738 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9739 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009740 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9741 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9742 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9743 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9744 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9745 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009747 Supported in default-server: Yes
9748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009749
97506. HTTP header manipulation
9751---------------------------
9752
9753In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9754response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9755request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9756which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009757against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009758
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009759If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9760to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9761but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9762HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9763stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9764because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9765a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9766still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009768This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9769in section 4.2 :
9770
9771 - reqadd <string>
9772 - reqallow <search>
9773 - reqiallow <search>
9774 - reqdel <search>
9775 - reqidel <search>
9776 - reqdeny <search>
9777 - reqideny <search>
9778 - reqpass <search>
9779 - reqipass <search>
9780 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9781 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9782 - reqtarpit <search>
9783 - reqitarpit <search>
9784 - rspadd <string>
9785 - rspdel <search>
9786 - rspidel <search>
9787 - rspdeny <search>
9788 - rspideny <search>
9789 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9790 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9791
9792With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9793is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9794parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9795prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9796Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9797
9798 \t for a tab
9799 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9800 \n for a new line (LF)
9801 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9802 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9803 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9804 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9805 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9806
9807The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9808portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9809above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9810regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
98119 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9812is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9813
9814The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9815after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9816
9817Notes related to these keywords :
9818---------------------------------
9819 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9820 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9821 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9822
9823 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9824 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9825 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9826
9827 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9828 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9829 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9830 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9831 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9832
9833 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9834 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9835 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9836 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9837 useless headers before adding new ones.
9838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009839 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009840 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9841
9842 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9843 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9844 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9845
9846 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9847 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009848 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009849
9850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098517. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9852----------------------------------
9853
9854Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9855client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9856The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9857these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9858but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9859data called patterns.
9860
9861
98627.1. ACL basics
9863---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009864
9865The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9866content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9867from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9868simple :
9869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009871 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009872 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9873 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009875The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9876adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009877
9878In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009880 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009881
9882This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9883Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9884and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009885an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9886conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9887as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9888are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009889
9890ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9891'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9892which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9893
9894There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9895performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9898specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9899this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009900methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9901ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902
9903Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9904 - boolean
9905 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9906 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9907 - string
9908 - data block
9909
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009910Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9911converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9912would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9913The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9914which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9915
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009916Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9917keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9918fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9919which are summarized in the table below :
9920
9921 +---------------------+-----------------+
9922 | Sample or converter | Default |
9923 | output type | matching method |
9924 +---------------------+-----------------+
9925 | boolean | bool |
9926 +---------------------+-----------------+
9927 | integer | int |
9928 +---------------------+-----------------+
9929 | ip | ip |
9930 +---------------------+-----------------+
9931 | string | str |
9932 +---------------------+-----------------+
9933 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9934 +---------------------+-----------------+
9935
9936Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9937matching method, see below.
9938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9940 - boolean
9941 - integer or integer range
9942 - IP address / network
9943 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9944 - regular expression
9945 - hex block
9946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009947The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9948
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009949 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9950 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009951 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009952 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009953 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009954 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009955 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009957The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9958read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9959if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9960lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9961will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9962beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9963a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9964lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9965exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9966
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009967The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9968parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9969ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9970a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9971check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9972
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009973The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9974socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9975file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9978loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9979
9980 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9981
9982In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9983the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9984case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9985as well.
9986
9987The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9988sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9989do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9990methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9991is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9992obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9993followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9994default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9995that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9996string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9997
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009998The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9999By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10000string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10001resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10002server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10003waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10004flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10005function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010007There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10008sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10009be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010010
10011 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10012 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10014 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10015 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10016 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010017
10018 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10019 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010021
10022 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010023 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010024
10025 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010026 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010027
10028 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10029 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10030
10031 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10032 binary or string samples.
10033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10035 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010037 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10038 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10039 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010041 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10042 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10045 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10048 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010050 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10051 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010052 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010054 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10055 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10056 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010057
10058For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10059request, it is possible to do :
10060
10061 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10062
10063In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10064buffer, one would use the following acl :
10065
10066 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10067
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010068On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10069possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10070
10071 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10074criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10075method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10076to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10077criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10078the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010081the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10082For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10085 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10086 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10087 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010088
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010089
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010090The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10091types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10092combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10093brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10094default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010096 +-------------------------------------------------+
10097 | Input sample type |
10098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010099 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10101 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010103 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010105 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010107 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010109 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010111 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010113 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010114 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010115 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010116 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010117 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010119 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010121 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010123 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10125 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10126 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010127
10128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101297.1.1. Matching booleans
10130------------------------
10131
10132In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10133Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10134When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10135that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10136
10137Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10138return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10139"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101427.1.2. Matching integers
10143------------------------
10144
10145Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10146enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10147to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10148
10149Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10150matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10151lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010152
10153For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10154unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10155representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10156
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010157As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10158two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10159instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10160ranges and operators.
10161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010162For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010163operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10164Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10165of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010167Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010168
10169 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10170 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10171 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10172 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10173 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010175For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010176
10177 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10178
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010179This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10180
10181 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10182
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101847.1.3. Matching strings
10185-----------------------
10186
10187String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10188different forms :
10189
10190 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10191 patterns ;
10192
10193 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10194 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10195
10196 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10197 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10198
10199 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10200 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10201
10202 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10203 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10204 matches.
10205
10206 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10207 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10208 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010209
10210String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10211exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10212characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10213string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10214to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010215before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010216
10217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102187.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10219---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010220
10221Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10222they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10223possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10224passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10225the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010226the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10227match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010228
10229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102307.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10231-------------------------------------
10232
10233It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10234not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10235a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10236to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10237digits may be used upper or lower case.
10238
10239Example :
10240 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10241 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10242
10243
102447.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10245---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010246
10247IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10248netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10249within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010250host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010251difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10252at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10253does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10254parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010255
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010256IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10257Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10258trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10259IPv6 patterns.
10260
10261HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10262following situations :
10263 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10264 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10265 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10266 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10267 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10268 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10269 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10270 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10271 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10272 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010274
102757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10276----------------------------------
10277
10278Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10279combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10280
10281 - AND (implicit)
10282 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10283 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010287 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010289Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10290indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10293"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10294requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10295is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10296
10297 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10298 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10299 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10300 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10301
10302To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10303and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10304
10305 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10306 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10307 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10308 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10309
10310 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10311 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10312 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10313 use_backend www if host_www
10314
10315It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10316expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10317be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10318the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10319
10320 The following rule :
10321
10322 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10323 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10324
10325 Can also be written that way :
10326
10327 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10328
10329It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10330to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10331simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10332sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10333good use is the following :
10334
10335 With named ACLs :
10336
10337 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10338 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10339 monitor fail if site_dead
10340
10341 With anonymous ACLs :
10342
10343 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10344
10345See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10346
10347
103487.3. Fetching samples
10349---------------------
10350
10351Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10352against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10353sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10354ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10355of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10356available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10357
10358This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10359Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10360compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10361deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10362
10363The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10364matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10365method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10366indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10367
10368As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10369when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10370mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10371the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10372ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10373
10374Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10375multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10376when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10377incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10378are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10379is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10380all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10381
10382Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10383 - name
10384 - name(arg1)
10385 - name(arg1,arg2)
10386
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010387
103887.3.1. Converters
10389-----------------
10390
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010391Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10392of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10393is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10394was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10395has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10396unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10397
10398These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10399sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10400the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10401support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010402
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010403A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10404support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10405supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10406(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10407bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010409The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010410
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010411add(<value>)
10412 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10413 result as an unsigned integer.
10414
10415and(<value>)
10416 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10417 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10418
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010419base64
10420 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10421 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10422 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10423
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010424bool
10425 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10426 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10427 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10428 presence of a flag).
10429
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010430bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10431 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10432 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10433 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10434
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010435cpl
10436 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10437 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10438
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010439crc32([<avalanche>])
10440 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10441 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10442 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10443 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10444 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10445 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10446 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10447 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10448 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10449 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10450 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10451
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010452div(<value>)
10453 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10454 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10455 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10456
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010457djb2([<avalanche>])
10458 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10459 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10460 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10461 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10462 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10463 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10464 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010465 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10466 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010467
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010468even
10469 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10470 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10471
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010472field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10473 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10474 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10475 list of chars.
10476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010477hex
10478 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10479 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10480 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10481 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010482
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010483http_date([<offset>])
10484 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10485 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10486 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10487 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10488 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10489 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010491in_table(<table>)
10492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10494 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10495 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10496 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10497
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010498ipmask(<mask>)
10499 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10500 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10501 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10502 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10503
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010504json([<input-code>])
10505 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10506 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10507 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10508 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10509 of errors:
10510 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10511 bytes, ...)
10512 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10513 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10514
10515 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10516 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10517 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10518 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10519 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10520 are :
10521 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10522 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10523 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10524 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10525 error ;
10526 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10527 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10528
10529 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10530 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10531
10532 Example:
10533 capture request header user-agent len 150
10534 capture request header Host len 15
10535 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10536
10537 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10538 GET / HTTP/1.0
10539 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10540
10541 Output log:
10542 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010544language(<value>[,<default>])
10545 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10546 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10547 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10548 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10549 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10550 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10551 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10552 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10553 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10554 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10555 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10556 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010557
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010558 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010560 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10561 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010563 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10564 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10565 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10566 use_backend spanish if es
10567 use_backend french if fr
10568 use_backend english if en
10569 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010570
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010571lower
10572 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10573 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10574 type. The result is of type string.
10575
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010576ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10577 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10578 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10579 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10580 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10581 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10582 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10583
10584 Example :
10585
10586 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10587 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10588 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010590map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10591map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10592map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10593 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10594 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10595 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10596 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10597 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10598 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10599 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10600 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010601
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010602 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10603 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10604 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010605
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010606 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10607 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010609 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10611 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010613 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10614 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010615 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10616 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10617 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10619 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10621 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10622 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10623 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10625 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10626 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10627 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10628 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010630 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10631 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10632 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10633 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10634 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010635
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010636 Example :
10637
10638 # this is a comment and is ignored
10639 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10640 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10641 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10642 | | | `---------- value
10643 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10644 | `---------------------------- key
10645 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10646
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010647mod(<value>)
10648 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10649 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10650
10651mul(<value>)
10652 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10653 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10654 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10655
10656neg
10657 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10658 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10659 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10660 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10661
10662not
10663 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10664 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10665 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10666 absence of a flag).
10667
10668odd
10669 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10670 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10671
10672or(<value>)
10673 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10674 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10675
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010676regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010677 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10678 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10679 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10680 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10681 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10682 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10683 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10684 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10685 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10686 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10687 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10688 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10689 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10690
10691 Example :
10692
10693 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10694 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10695 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10696 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10697
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010698sdbm([<avalanche>])
10699 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10700 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10701 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10702 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10703 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10704 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10705 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010706 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10707 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010708
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010709sub(<value>)
10710 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10711 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10712 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10713
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010714table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10717 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10718 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10719 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10720 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10721
10722
10723table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10724 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10725 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10726 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10727 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10728 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10729 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10730
10731table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10732 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10733 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10734 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10735 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10736 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10737
10738table_conn_cur(<table>)
10739 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10740 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10741 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10742 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10743 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10744
10745table_conn_rate(<table>)
10746 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10747 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10748 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10749 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10750 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10751
10752table_gpc0(<table>)
10753 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10754 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10755 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10756 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10757 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10758
10759table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10760 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10761 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10762 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10763 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10764 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10765 sample fetch keyword.
10766
10767table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10768 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10769 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10770 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10771 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10772 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10773
10774table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10777 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10778 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10779 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10780 keyword.
10781
10782table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10783 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10784 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10785 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10786 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10787 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10788
10789table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10790 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10791 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10792 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10793 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10794 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10795 keyword.
10796
10797table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10801 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10802 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10803 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10804 keyword.
10805
10806table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10810 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10811 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10812 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10813 keyword.
10814
10815table_server_id(<table>)
10816 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10817 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10818 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10819 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10820 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10821 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10822
10823table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10826 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10827 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10828 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10829 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10830 keyword.
10831
10832table_sess_rate(<table>)
10833 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10834 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10835 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10836 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10837 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10838 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10839 keyword.
10840
10841table_trackers(<table>)
10842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10845 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10846 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10847 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10848 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10849 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10850 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10851 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10852
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010853upper
10854 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10855 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10856 type. The result is of type string.
10857
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010858utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10859 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10860 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10861 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10862 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10863 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10864 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10865
10866 Example :
10867
10868 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10869 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10870 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10871
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010872word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10873 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10874 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10875
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010876wt6([<avalanche>])
10877 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10878 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10879 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10880 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10881 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10882 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10883 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010884 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10885 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010886
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010887xor(<value>)
10888 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10889 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10890
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108927.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893--------------------------------------------
10894
10895A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10896not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10897"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10898The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10899
10900always_false : boolean
10901 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10902 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10903
10904always_true : boolean
10905 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10906 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10907
10908avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010909 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10911 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10912 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10913 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10914 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10915 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10916 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10917 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10918 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10919 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10920 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10921 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10922 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010924be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010925 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10926 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10927 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10928 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10929 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010931be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10932 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10933 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10934 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10935 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10936 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10937 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938
10939 Example :
10940 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10941 backend dynamic
10942 mode http
10943 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10944 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010946connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10947 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010948 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10950 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010951
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010952 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010953 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010954 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10955
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010956 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10957 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010958
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010959 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010960 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010962 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10963 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010964 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010965 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010966
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010967 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10968 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010970 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010971
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010972date([<offset>]) : integer
10973 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10974 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10975 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10976 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010977 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10978
10979 Example :
10980
10981 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10982 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010983
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010984env(<name>) : string
10985 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10986 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10987 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10988 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10989 certain way.
10990
10991 Examples :
10992 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10993 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10994
10995 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10996 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10999 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011000 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11001 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11003 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11004 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11005 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11006 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011008fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11009 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11010 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11011 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11012 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11013 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11014 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11015 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11016 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011017
11018 Example :
11019 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11020 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11021 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11022 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11023 frontend mail
11024 bind :25
11025 mode tcp
11026 maxconn 100
11027 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11028 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11029 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11030 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011031
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011032nbproc : integer
11033 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11034 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11035 and debugging purposes.
11036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011037nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11039 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11040 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11042 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11043 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011044
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011045proc : integer
11046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11047 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11048 debugging purposes.
11049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011051 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11052 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11053 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011054 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11055 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11056 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11057 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11058 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11059
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011060rand([<range>]) : integer
11061 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11062 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11063 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11064 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11065 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11068 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11069 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11070 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11071 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11072 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11073 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11074 methods.
11075
11076srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11077 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11078 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11079 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11080 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11081 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11082 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11083 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11084
11085srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11086 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11087 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011088 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11090 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11091 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11092 overloading servers).
11093
11094 Example :
11095 # Redirect to a separate back
11096 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11097 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11098 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11099
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011100stopping : boolean
11101 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11102 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11103 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11106 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11107 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11108
11109table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11110 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11111 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11112 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11113
11114
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111157.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116----------------------------------
11117
11118The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11119closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11120methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11121sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11122TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011123the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11124counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11125"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011126argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11127the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11128this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011129
11130be_id : integer
11131 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11132 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11133
11134dst : ip
11135 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11136 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11137 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11138 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11139 RFC 4291.
11140
11141dst_conn : integer
11142 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11143 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11144 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11145 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11146 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11147 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11148 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11149 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011151dst_port : integer
11152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11153 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11154 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11155 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11156 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11157 an HTTP header.
11158
11159fe_id : integer
11160 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11161 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11162 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11163
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011164sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011165sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11166sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11167sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011168 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11169 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11170 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011172sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011173sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11174sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11175sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011176 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11177 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11178 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011180sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011181sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11182sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11183sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011184 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11185 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011186 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11187 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11188 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011189
11190 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11191 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011192 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11193 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11194 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011195 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11196 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011198sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011199sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11200sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11201sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011202 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11203 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11204
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011205sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011206sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11207sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11208sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011209 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11210 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11211 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11212
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011213sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011214sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11215sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11216sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011217 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11218 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11219 See also src_conn_rate.
11220
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011221sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011222sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11223sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11224sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011225 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011226 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011227
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011228sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011229sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11230sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11231sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011232 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11233 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11234 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011235 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11236 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11237 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011238
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011239sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011240sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11241sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11242sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011243 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11244 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11245 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11246
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011247sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011248sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11249sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11250sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011251 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11252 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11253 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11254 src_http_err_rate.
11255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011256sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011257sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11258sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11259sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011260 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11261 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11262 src_http_req_cnt.
11263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011264sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011265sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11266sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11267sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011268 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11269 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11270 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11271 src_http_req_rate.
11272
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011273sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011274sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11275sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11276sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011277 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011278 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11279 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11280 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11281 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011282
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011283 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11284 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011285 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11286
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011287sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011288sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11289sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11290sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011291 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11292 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11293 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011295sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011296sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11297sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11298sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011299 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11300 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11301 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011303sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011304sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11305sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11306sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011307 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11308 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11309 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11310 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011311 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011312 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11313
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011314sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011315sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11316sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11317sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011318 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11319 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11320 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11321 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11322 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011323 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011325sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011326sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11327sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11328sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011329 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11330 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11331 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011333sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011334sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11335sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11336sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011337 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11338 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011339 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011340 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11341 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11343 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11344 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011346so_id : integer
11347 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11348 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11349 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011351src : ip
11352 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11353 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11354 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11355 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11356 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11357 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11358 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011360 Example:
11361 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11362 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11365 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11366 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11367 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011368 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011370src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11371 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11372 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011373 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011374 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11377 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11378 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11379 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11380 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11381 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11382 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011383
11384 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11385 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11386 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11387 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011388 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011389 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11390 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011393 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011395 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011396 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011398src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011399 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011400 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11401 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011402 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11405 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11406 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11407 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011408 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011411 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011413 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011414 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011417 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011419 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11420 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011421 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11422 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11423 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011425src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11426 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11427 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011429 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11433 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11434 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11435 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11436 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011437 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11440 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11441 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11442 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011443 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11446 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11447 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11448 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011449 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011450 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011452src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11453 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11454 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11455 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011456 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011457 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11458 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011459
11460 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011461 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011462 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011464src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011465 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11466 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11467 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11468 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11469 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011472 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11473 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11474 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11475 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11476 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478src_port : integer
11479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11480 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11481 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11482 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11485 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011486 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11487 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11488 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011489 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011491src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11492 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11493 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11494 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11495 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011496 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11499 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11500 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11501 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11502 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11503 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11504 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11505 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11506 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011507
11508 Example :
11509 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11510 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11511 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11512 listen ssh
11513 bind :22
11514 mode tcp
11515 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011516 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011518 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520srv_id : integer
11521 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11522 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11523 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011524
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115267.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11530closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11531when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11532usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011533future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011534
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011535ssl_bc : boolean
11536 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11537 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11538 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11539
11540ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11541 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11542 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11543
11544ssl_bc_cipher : string
11545 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11546 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11547
11548ssl_bc_protocol : string
11549 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11550 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11551
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011552ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011553 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011554 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11555 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011556
11557ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11558 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11559 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11560 if session was reused or not.
11561
11562ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11563 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11564 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011566ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11567 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11568 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11569 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11570 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11571 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011573ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11574 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11575 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11576 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11577 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011578
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011579ssl_c_der : binary
11580 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11581 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11582 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584ssl_c_err : integer
11585 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11586 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11587 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11588 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11589 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011591ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11592 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11593 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11594 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11595 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11596 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11597 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11598 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11599 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601ssl_c_key_alg : string
11602 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11603 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11604 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011606ssl_c_notafter : string
11607 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11608 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11609 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011611ssl_c_notbefore : string
11612 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11613 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11614 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11617 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11618 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11619 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11620 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11621 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11622 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11623 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11624 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011626ssl_c_serial : binary
11627 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11628 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11629 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011631ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11632 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11633 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11634 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011635 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11636 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11637
11638 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011640ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11641 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11642 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11643 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645ssl_c_used : boolean
11646 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11647 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011649ssl_c_verify : integer
11650 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11651 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11652 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11653 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655ssl_c_version : integer
11656 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11657 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011658
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011659ssl_f_der : binary
11660 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11661 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11662 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11665 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11666 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11667 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11668 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011669 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011670 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11671 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11672 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011674ssl_f_key_alg : string
11675 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11676 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11677 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679ssl_f_notafter : string
11680 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11681 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11682 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011684ssl_f_notbefore : string
11685 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11686 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11687 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11691 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11692 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11693 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11694 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11695 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11696 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11697 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699ssl_f_serial : binary
11700 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11701 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11702 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011703
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011704ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11705 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11706 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11707 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011709ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11710 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11711 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11712 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011714ssl_f_version : integer
11715 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11716 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11717
11718ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011719 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11720 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11721 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723 Example :
11724 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11725 listen http-https
11726 bind :80
11727 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11728 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11729
11730ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11731 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11732 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11733
11734ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011735 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011736 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11737 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11738 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11739 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11740 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11741 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11742 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11743 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745ssl_fc_cipher : string
11746 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11747 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011749ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011750 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11751 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011752 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11753 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11754 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11755 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11758 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011759 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11760 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11761 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11762 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011764ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011765 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011766 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11767 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11768 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11769 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11770 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11771 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11772 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774ssl_fc_protocol : string
11775 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11776 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011777
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011778ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011779 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011780 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11781 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011783ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11784 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11785 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11786 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11787 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789ssl_fc_sni : string
11790 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11791 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11792 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11793 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11794 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11795
11796 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11797 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11798 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011799 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11800 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011803 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11804 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11807 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11808 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011809
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011810
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118117.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11815sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11816only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11817For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11818be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11819can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11820sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11821for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11822content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011824payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11825 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11826 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11827 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011829payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11830 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11831 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11832 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834req.len : integer
11835req_len : integer (deprecated)
11836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11837 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11838 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11839 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11840 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11841 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11842 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11843 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11846 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011847 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11848 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11849 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11850 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011852 ACL alternatives :
11853 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011855req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11856 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11857 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11858 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11859 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861 ACL alternatives :
11862 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011866req.proto_http : boolean
11867req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11868 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11869 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11870 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11871 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11872 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11873 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11874 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876 Example:
11877 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11878 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11879 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011880 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011882req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11883rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11884 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11885 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11886 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11887 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11888 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11889 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11890 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011892 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11893 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11894 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11895 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11896 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11897 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011899 ACL derivatives :
11900 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011902 Example :
11903 listen tse-farm
11904 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11905 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11906 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11907 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11908 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11909 persist rdp-cookie
11910 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11911 # This is only useful makes sense if
11912 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11913 stick-table type string size 204800
11914 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11915 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11916 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11919 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11922rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11923 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11924 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11925 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11926 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928 ACL derivatives :
11929 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11932req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11933 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11934 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11935 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11936 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11937 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11938 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11939 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941req.ssl_sni : string
11942req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11943 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11944 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11945 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11946 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11947 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11948 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11949 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11950 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11951 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11952 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11953 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11954 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956 ACL derivatives :
11957 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011959 Examples :
11960 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11961 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11962 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11963 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11964 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011966res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11967rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11968 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11969 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11970 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11971 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11972 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11973 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11974 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011976req.ssl_ver : integer
11977req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11978 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11979 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11980 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11981 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11982 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11983 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11984 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11985 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11986 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988 ACL derivatives :
11989 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011990
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011991res.len : integer
11992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11993 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11994 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11995 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11996 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11997 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11998 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11999 content inspection.
12000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012001res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12002 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012003 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12004 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12005 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12006 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012008res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12009 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12010 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12011 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12012 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016wait_end : boolean
12017 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12018 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12019 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12020 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12021 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12022 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12023 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12024 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012026 Examples :
12027 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12028 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12029 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012031 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12032 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12033 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12034 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12035 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12036 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12037 tcp-request content reject
12038
12039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120407.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041--------------------------------------
12042
12043It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12044This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12045data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12046its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12047HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12048content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12049to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12050more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12051response are indexed.
12052
12053base : string
12054 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12055 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12056 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12057 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12058 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12059 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12060 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12061 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12062
12063 ACL derivatives :
12064 base : exact string match
12065 base_beg : prefix match
12066 base_dir : subdir match
12067 base_dom : domain match
12068 base_end : suffix match
12069 base_len : length match
12070 base_reg : regex match
12071 base_sub : substring match
12072
12073base32 : integer
12074 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12075 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12076 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012077 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12078 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12079 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012080
12081base32+src : binary
12082 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12083 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12084 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12085 per-URL counters.
12086
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012087capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12088 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12089 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12090 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12091
12092capture.req.method : string
12093 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12094 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12095 because it's allocated.
12096
12097capture.req.uri : string
12098 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12099 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12100 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12101 allocated.
12102
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012103capture.req.ver : string
12104 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12105 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12106 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12107
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012108capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12109 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12110 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12111 The first entry is an index of 0.
12112 See also: "capture response header"
12113
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012114capture.res.ver : string
12115 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12116 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12117 persistent flag.
12118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012119req.cook([<name>]) : string
12120cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12121 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12122 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12123 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12124 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12125 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12126 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12127 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12128 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12129
12130 ACL derivatives :
12131 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12132 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12133 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12134 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12135 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12136 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12137 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12138 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12141cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12142 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12143 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12146cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12147 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12148 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12149 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12150 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12153 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12154 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12155 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12156 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12157 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12158 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12159 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12160 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12161 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12162 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012164hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12165 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12166 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12167 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12168 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012169 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12172 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12173 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12174 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12175 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12176 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12177 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12178 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12179 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12182 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12183 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12184 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12185 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012187req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12188 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12189 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12190 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12191 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12192 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12193 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12194 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12195 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12196 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12197 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12198 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200 ACL derivatives :
12201 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12202 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12203 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12204 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12205 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12206 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12207 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12208 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12209
12210req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12211hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12212 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12213 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12214 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12215 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12216 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12217 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12218 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12219 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12220 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12221
12222req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12223hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12224 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12225 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12226 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12227 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12228 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12229 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12230 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12231 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12232
12233req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12234hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12236 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12237 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12238 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12239 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12240 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12241 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12242
12243http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12244 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12245 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12246 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12247 basic auth is supported.
12248
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012249http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12250 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12251 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12252 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12253 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012254 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12255 basic auth is supported.
12256
12257 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012258 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12259 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12260 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12261 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262
12263http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012264 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12265 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12267 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012269method : integer + string
12270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12271 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12272 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12273 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12274 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12275 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12276 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278 ACL derivatives :
12279 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281 Example :
12282 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12283 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12284 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012286path : string
12287 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12288 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12289 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12290 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12291 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12292 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12293 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012295 ACL derivatives :
12296 path : exact string match
12297 path_beg : prefix match
12298 path_dir : subdir match
12299 path_dom : domain match
12300 path_end : suffix match
12301 path_len : length match
12302 path_reg : regex match
12303 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012304
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012305query : string
12306 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12307 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12308 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12309 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12310 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12311 which stops before the question mark.
12312
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012313req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12314 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12315 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12316 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12317 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012319req.ver : string
12320req_ver : string (deprecated)
12321 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12322 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12323 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012325 ACL derivatives :
12326 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328res.comp : boolean
12329 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12330 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12331 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012333res.comp_algo : string
12334 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12335 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12336 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338res.cook([<name>]) : string
12339scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12340 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12341 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12342 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012344 ACL derivatives :
12345 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12348scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12349 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12350 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12351 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12354scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12356 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12357 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012359res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12360 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12361 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12362 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12363 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12364 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12365 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12366 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12367 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12368 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012370res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12372 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12373 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12374 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12375 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012377res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12378shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12379 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12380 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12381 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12382 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12383 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12384 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12385 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12386 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388 ACL derivatives :
12389 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12390 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12391 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12392 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12393 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12394 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12395 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12396 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12397
12398res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12399shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12400 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12401 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12402 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12403 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12404 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12407shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12409 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12410 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12411 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12412 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12413 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012414
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012415res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12416 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12417 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12418 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12419 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012421res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12422shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12423 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12424 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12425 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12426 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12427 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12428 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012430res.ver : string
12431resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12432 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12433 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012435 ACL derivatives :
12436 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012438set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12439 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12440 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12441 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12442 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012444 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12445 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012447 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012449status : integer
12450 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12451 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12452 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012454url : string
12455 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12456 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12457 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12458 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12459 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12460 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12461 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012463 ACL derivatives :
12464 url : exact string match
12465 url_beg : prefix match
12466 url_dir : subdir match
12467 url_dom : domain match
12468 url_end : suffix match
12469 url_len : length match
12470 url_reg : regex match
12471 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012473url_ip : ip
12474 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12475 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12476 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12477 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12478 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12479 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12480 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012482url_port : integer
12483 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12484 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12485 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12486 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12489url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12490 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12491 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12492 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12493 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12494 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12495 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12496 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12497 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12498 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012500 ACL derivatives :
12501 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12502 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12503 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12504 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12505 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12506 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12507 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12508 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012509
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012511 Example :
12512 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12513 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12514 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12515 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012517urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12518 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12519 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12520 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012521
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125237.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012524---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012526Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12527every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012528order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012530ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12531---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012532FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012533HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012534HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12535HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012536HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12537HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12538HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12539HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12540LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012541METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12542METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12543METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12544METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12545METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12546METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012547RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012548REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012549TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012550WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12551---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012552
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125548. Logging
12555----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012557One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12558provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12559very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12560provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12561state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012562to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012563headers.
12564
12565In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12566about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12567send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12568
12569 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12570 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12571 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12572 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12573 at the termination.
12574
12575The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12576allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12577as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12578while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12579real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12580delay.
12581
12582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125838.1. Log levels
12584---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012585
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012586TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012587source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012588HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12589in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12590track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12591syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12592about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012593
12594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125958.2. Log formats
12596----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012597
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012598HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012599and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12600slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12601options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012602
12603 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12604 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12605 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12606 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12607 extents.
12608
12609 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12610 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12611 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12612 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12613 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12614
12615 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12616 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12617 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12618 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12619 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12620
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012621 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12622 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12623 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12624 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12625
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012626 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012628Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12629specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12630field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12631servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12632always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12633identifier.
12634
12635Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12636 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12637 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12638 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12639 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12640
12641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126428.2.1. Default log format
12643-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012644
12645This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12646as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12647format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12648
12649 Example :
12650 listen www
12651 mode http
12652 log global
12653 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12654
12655 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12656 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12657 (www/HTTP)
12658
12659 Field Format Extract from the example above
12660 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12661 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12662 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12663 4 'to' to
12664 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12665 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12666
12667Detailed fields description :
12668 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12669 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12670 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12671 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12672 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12673 and processed the connection.
12674 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12675
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012676In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12677"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12678connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12679
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012680It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12681will eventually disappear.
12682
12683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126848.2.2. TCP log format
12685---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012686
12687The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12688is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12689information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12690counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12691emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12692environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12693the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12694sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012695specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12696not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12697fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12698marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012699
12700 Example :
12701 frontend fnt
12702 mode tcp
12703 option tcplog
12704 log global
12705 default_backend bck
12706
12707 backend bck
12708 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12709
12710 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12711 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12712 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12713
12714 Field Format Extract from the example above
12715 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12716 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12717 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12718 4 frontend_name fnt
12719 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12720 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12721 7 bytes_read* 212
12722 8 termination_state --
12723 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12724 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12725
12726Detailed fields description :
12727 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012728 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12729 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12730 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12731 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12732 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012733
12734 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012735 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12736 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12737 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012738
12739 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12740 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12741 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12742 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12743
12744 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12745 and processed the connection.
12746
12747 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12748 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12749 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12750 applications.
12751
12752 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12753 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12754 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12755 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12756 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12757
12758 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12759 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12760 See "Timers" below for more details.
12761
12762 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12763 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12764 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12765 "Timers" below for more details.
12766
12767 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012768 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012769 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12770 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12771 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12772 details.
12773
12774 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12775 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12776 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12777 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12778 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12779
12780 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12781 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12782 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12783 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12784 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12785 for more details.
12786
12787 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012788 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012789 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12790 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12791 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012792 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012793
12794 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12795 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12796 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12797 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12798 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12799 caused by a denial of service attack.
12800
12801 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12802 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12803 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12804 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12805 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12806 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12807 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12808 denial of service attack.
12809
12810 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12811 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12812 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12813 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12814 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12815 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12816 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12817 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12818 be processed than on other servers.
12819
12820 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12821 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12822 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12823 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12824 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12825 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12826 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12827 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12828 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12829 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12830 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12831 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12832 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12833
12834 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12835 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12836 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12837 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12838 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12839 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12840 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12841 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12842
12843 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12844 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12845 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12846 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12847 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12848 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12849 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12850 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12851 occurs.
12852
12853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128548.2.3. HTTP log format
12855----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012856
12857The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12858is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12859the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12860are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12861emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12862generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12863"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12864which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012865frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12866is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012867
12868Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12869slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12870with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12871
12872 Example :
12873 frontend http-in
12874 mode http
12875 option httplog
12876 log global
12877 default_backend bck
12878
12879 backend static
12880 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12881
12882 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12883 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12884 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012885 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012886
12887 Field Format Extract from the example above
12888 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12889 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12890 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12891 4 frontend_name http-in
12892 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12893 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12894 7 status_code 200
12895 8 bytes_read* 2750
12896 9 captured_request_cookie -
12897 10 captured_response_cookie -
12898 11 termination_state ----
12899 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12900 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12901 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12902 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12903 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012904
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012905
12906Detailed fields description :
12907 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012908 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12909 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12910 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12911 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12912 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012913
12914 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012915 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12916 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12917 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012918
12919 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12920 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12921 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12922 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12923 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12924
12925 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12926 and processed the connection.
12927
12928 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12929 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12930 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12931
12932 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12933 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12934 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12935 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12936 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12937 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12938
12939 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12940 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12941 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12942 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12943 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12944 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12945
12946 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12947 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12948 See "Timers" below for more details.
12949
12950 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12951 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12952 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12953 below for more details.
12954
12955 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12956 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12957 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12958 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12959 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12960 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12961 for more details.
12962
12963 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012964 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012965 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12966 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12967 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12968 details.
12969
12970 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12971 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12972 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12973
12974 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12975 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12976 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12977 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12978 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12979 overflowing.
12980
12981 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12982 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12983 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12984 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12985 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12986 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12987 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12988 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12989
12990 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12991 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12992 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12993 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12994 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12995 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12996 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12997 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12998
12999 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13000 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13001 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13002 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13003 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13004 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13005 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13006
13007 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013008 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013009 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13010 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13011 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013012 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013013 system.
13014
13015 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13016 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13017 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13018 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13019 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13020 caused by a denial of service attack.
13021
13022 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13023 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13024 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13025 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13026 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13027 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13028 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13029 denial of service attack.
13030
13031 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13032 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13033 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13034 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13035 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13036 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13037 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13038 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13039 processed than on other servers.
13040
13041 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13042 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13043 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13044 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13045 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13046 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13047 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13048 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13049 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13050 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13051 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13052 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13053 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13054
13055 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13056 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13057 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13058 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13059 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13060 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13061 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13062 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13063
13064 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13065 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13066 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13067 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13068 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13069 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13070 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13071 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13072 occurs.
13073
13074 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13075 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13076 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13077 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13078 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13079 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13080 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13081 cookies" below for more details.
13082
13083 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13084 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13085 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13086 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13087 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13088 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13089 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13090 and cookies" below for more details.
13091
13092 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13093 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13094 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13095 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13096 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13097 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13098 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13099 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13100
13101
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200131028.2.4. Custom log format
13103------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013104
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013105The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013106mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013107
13108HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13109Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13110separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13111prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13112
13113Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13114variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13115string formats ("Q").
13116
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013117If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013118as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013119less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13120the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13121
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013122Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013123In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013124in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013125
13126Flags are :
13127 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013128 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013129
13130 Example:
13131
13132 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13133 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13134
13135At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13136
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013137 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13138 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013139
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013140the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013141
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013142 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013143 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013144 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013145
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013146and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13147
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013148 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013149 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13150
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013151Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13152
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013153 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013154 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013155 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13156 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13157 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013158 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13159 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13160 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013161 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013162 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013163 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013164 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013165 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013166 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013167 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13168 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013169 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013170 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13171 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013172 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013173 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13174 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013175 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13176 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13177 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013178 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013179 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13180 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013181 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013182 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13183 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13184 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013185 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013186 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013187 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13188 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13189 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13190 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013191 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013192 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013193 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013194 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013195 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013196 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013197 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13198 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13199 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013200 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013201 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13202 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013203 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013204 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013205 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013206 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013207
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013208 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013209
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013210
132118.2.5. Error log format
13212-----------------------
13213
13214When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13215protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13216By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13217"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13218will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13219logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13220
13221The format looks like this :
13222
13223 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13224 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13225 Connection error during SSL handshake
13226
13227 Field Format Extract from the example above
13228 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13229 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13230 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13231 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13232 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13233
13234These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13235failures.
13236
13237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132388.3. Advanced logging options
13239-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013240
13241Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13242just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13243options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13244for more information about their usage.
13245
13246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132478.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13248------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013249
13250It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13251haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13252commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13253monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13254ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13255
13256 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13257 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13258 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13259 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13260
13261 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13262 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13263 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013264 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013265 such as other load-balancers.
13266
13267 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13268 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13269 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13270
13271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132728.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13273----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013274
13275The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13276what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13277or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13278"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13279just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13280log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13281after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13282is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13283with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13284with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13285
13286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132878.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13288------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013289
13290Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13291for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13292"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13293retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13294raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13295a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13296file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13297you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13298"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13299
13300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133018.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13302--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013303
13304Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13305multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13306them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13307"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13308logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13309error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13310and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13311too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13312useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13313alternative.
13314
13315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133168.4. Timing events
13317------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013318
13319Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13320reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13321the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13322frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13323mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13324
13325 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13326 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13327 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13328 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13329 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13330
13331 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13332 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13333 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13334 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13335 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13336
13337 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13338 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13339 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13340 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13341 connection never established.
13342
13343 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13344 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13345 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13346 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13347 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13348 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13349 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13350 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13351 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13352 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13353 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13354
13355 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13356 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13357 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13358 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013359 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013360
13361 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13362
13363 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13364 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13365 negative.
13366
13367These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13368protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13369that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013370due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013371close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13372session has been aborted on timeout.
13373
13374Most common cases :
13375
13376 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13377 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13378 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13379 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13380 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13381 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13382 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13383 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13384 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013385 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13386 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13387 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013388
13389 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13390 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13391 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13392 of ms on remote networks.
13393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013394 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13395 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13396 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013397
13398 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13399 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13400 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13401 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13402 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13403 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13404 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13405 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13406 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13407 to the server until another one is released.
13408
13409Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13410
13411 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13412 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13413 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13414
13415 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13416 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13417 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13418
13419 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13420 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13421 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13422 flags.
13423
13424 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13425 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13426 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13427 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13428 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13429 the client connection was maintained open.
13430
13431 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013432 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013433 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13434 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13435
13436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134378.5. Session state at disconnection
13438-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013439
13440TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13441"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
134422-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13443each of which has a special meaning :
13444
13445 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13446 session to terminate :
13447
13448 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13449
13450 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13451 server explicitly refused it.
13452
13453 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13454 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13455 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13456 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013457 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13458
13459 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13460 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013461
13462 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13463 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13464 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13465 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13466 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13467
13468 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13469 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13470 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13471 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13472 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13473
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013474 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13475 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13476
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013477 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13478 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13479 backup connections when going up.
13480
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013481 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013483 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13484 send or receive data.
13485
13486 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13487 send or receive data.
13488
13489 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13490 with nothing left in the buffers.
13491
13492 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13493
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013494 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013495 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13496
13497 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13498 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13499 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13500 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13501 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13502
13503 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13504 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13505
13506 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13507 server (HTTP only).
13508
13509 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13510
13511 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13512 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13513 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13514
13515 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13516 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13517 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13518
13519 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13520
13521 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13522 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13523
13524 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13525 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13526 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13527
13528 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13529 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013530 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13531 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013532
13533 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13534 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13535 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13536 another server.
13537
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013538 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013539 server.
13540
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013541 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13542 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13543 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13544 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13545
13546 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13547 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13548 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13549 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13550
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013551 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13552 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13553 "use-server" rule).
13554
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013555 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13556
13557 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13558 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13559
13560 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13561
13562 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13563 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13564 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13565
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013566 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13567 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013568 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013569 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13570 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13571
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013572 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13573
13574 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13575 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13576
13577 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13578
13579 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13580
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013581The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13582was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013583helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13584starvation, attacks, etc...
13585
13586The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13587alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13588easier finding and understanding.
13589
13590 Flags Reason
13591
13592 -- Normal termination.
13593
13594 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13595 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13596 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13597 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13598
13599 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13600 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13601 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13602 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13603 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13604 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013606 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13607 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013608 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013609
13610 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13611 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13612 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13613
13614 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13615 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13616 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13617 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13618 the server takes too long to respond.
13619
13620 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13621 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13622 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13623 long a time to respond.
13624
13625 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13626 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13627 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13628 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13629 and the client.
13630
13631 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13632 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13633 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13634 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13635 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013636 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13637 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13638 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13639 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13640 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13641 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13642 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13643 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13644 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13645 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13646 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13647 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13648 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13649 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013650
13651 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13652 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013653 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13654 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13655 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13656 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013657
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013658 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13659 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013661 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013662 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13663 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13664 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13665 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13666 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13667
13668 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13669 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13670 503 or 504 here.
13671
13672 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13673 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13674 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13675 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13676 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13677
13678 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13679 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013680 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013681 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13682 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13683
13684 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13685 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13686 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13687 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13688 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13689 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13690 between haproxy and the server.
13691
13692 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13693 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13694 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13695 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13696 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13697 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13698 solution is to fix the application.
13699
13700 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13701 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13702 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13703 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13704 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13705 external attacks.
13706
13707 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13708 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013709 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013710 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13711 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13712
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013713 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13714 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13715 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013716 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13717 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013718
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013719 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13720 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13721 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13722 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013723 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13724 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13725 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13726 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13727 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013728
13729 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13730 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13731 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13732 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13733
13734 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13735 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13736 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13737 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13738
13739 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13740 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13741 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13742 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13743
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013744The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13745persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13746important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13747re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13748
13749 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13750
13751 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13752 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13753 set on a GET request.
13754
13755 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13756 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013757 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013758 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13759
13760 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13761 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13762 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13763
13764 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13765 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13766 already got a cookie.
13767
13768 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13769 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13770 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13771 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13772 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13773
13774 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13775 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13776 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13777
13778 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13779 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13780 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13781
13782 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13783 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13784
13785 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13786 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13787 then advertised in the response.
13788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137908.6. Non-printable characters
13791-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013792
13793In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13794consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13795converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13796prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13797being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13798escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13799is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13800'}' when logging headers.
13801
13802Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13803issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13804containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13805
13806Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13807the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13808performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13809
13810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13812---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013813
13814Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13815achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013816section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013817cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13818the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13819the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013820locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013821not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13822user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13823a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13824wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13825
13826 Examples :
13827 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13828 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13829
13830 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13831 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13832
13833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138348.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13835---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013836
13837Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13838proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13839the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13840server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13841
13842Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13843response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013844section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013845
13846It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013847time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13848appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013849are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13850and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13851follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13852request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13853in the logs.
13854
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013855As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13856frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13857an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013859 Example :
13860 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13861 listen proxy-out
13862 mode http
13863 option httplog
13864 option logasap
13865 log global
13866 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13867
13868 # log the name of the virtual server
13869 capture request header Host len 20
13870
13871 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13872 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13873
13874 # log the beginning of the referrer
13875 capture request header Referer len 20
13876
13877 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13878 capture response header Server len 20
13879
13880 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13881 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13882
13883 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13884 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13885
13886 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13887 capture response header Via len 20
13888
13889 # log the URL location during a redirection
13890 capture response header Location len 20
13891
13892 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13893 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13894 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13895 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13896 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13897
13898 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13899 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13900 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13901 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013902 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013903
13904 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13905 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13906 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13907 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13908 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013909 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013910
13911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139128.9. Examples of logs
13913---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013914
13915These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13916them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13917reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13918
13919 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13920 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13921 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13922
13923 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13924 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13925
13926 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13927 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13928 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13929
13930 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13931 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13932
13933 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13934 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13935 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13936
13937 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013938 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013939 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13940 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13941
13942 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13943 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13944 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13945
13946 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13947 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013948 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013949 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13950 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13951 to return the 502 and not the server.
13952
13953 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013954 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013955
13956 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13957 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13958 Nothing was sent to any server.
13959
13960 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13961 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13962
13963 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13964 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13965 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13966 send a 408 return code to the client.
13967
13968 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13969 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13970
13971 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13972 5 seconds ("c----").
13973
13974 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13975 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013976 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013977
13978 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013979 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013980 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13981 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13982 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13983 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13984 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013985
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139879. Statistics and monitoring
13988----------------------------
13989
13990It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13991mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13992CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13993Unix socket.
13994
13995
139969.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013997---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013998
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013999The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014000page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14001begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14002represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14003use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14004('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14005(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14006text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14007do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14008use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014009
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014010In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14011that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14012S (Servers).
14013
14014 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14015 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14016 any name for server/listener)
14017 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14018 number queued without a server assigned.
14019 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14020 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14021 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14022 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14023 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14024 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14025 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14026 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14027 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14028 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14029 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14030 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14031 "option checkcache".
14032 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14033 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14034 - read error from the client
14035 - client timeout
14036 - client closed connection
14037 - various bad requests from the client.
14038 - request was tarpitted.
14039 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14040 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14041 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14042 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14043 active servers).
14044 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14045 Some other errors are:
14046 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14047 - failure applying filters to the response.
14048 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14049 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14050 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14051 switched away from.
14052 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14053 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14054 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14055 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14056 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14057 the server is up.)
14058 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14059 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14060 counters for each server.
14061 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14062 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14063 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14064 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14065 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14066 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14067 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14068 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14069 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14070 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14071 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14072 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14073 of times that server was selected.
14074 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14075 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14076 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14077 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14078 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14079 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014080 UNK -> unknown
14081 INI -> initializing
14082 SOCKERR -> socket error
14083 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014084 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014085 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14086 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14087 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14088 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14089 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14090 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14091 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14092 disable-on-404
14093 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14094 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14095 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014096 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14097 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14098 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14099 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14100 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14101 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14102 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14103 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14104 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14105 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14106 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14107 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14108 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14109 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14110 (inc. in eresp)
14111 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14112 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14113 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14114 (CPU/BW limit)
14115 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14116 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14117 server/backend
14118 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14119 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14120 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14121 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14122 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14123 (0 for TCP)
14124 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14125 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014126
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141289.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014129-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014130
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014131The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14132necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14133A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14134issuing commands by hand :
14135
14136 global
14137 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14138 stats timeout 2m
14139
14140It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14141the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14142never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14143situations :
14144
14145 global
14146 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14147 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14148 stats timeout 2m
14149
14150To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14151swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14152to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14153syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14154
14155 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14156 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14157
14158The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14159script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14160for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14161
14162The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14163that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14164editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14165(eg: watch a counter).
14166
14167The socket supports two operation modes :
14168 - interactive
14169 - non-interactive
14170
14171The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14172this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14173sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14174mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14175commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14176example :
14177
14178 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14179
14180The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14181entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14182for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14183sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14184"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14185after processing the last command of the same line.
14186
14187For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14188"prompt" command :
14189
14190 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14191 prompt
14192 > show info
14193 ...
14194 >
14195
14196Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14197delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14198that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14199parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014200
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014201It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14202on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14203own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014204
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014205The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14206If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14207all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14208it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14209
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014210add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014211 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14212 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14213 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14214 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014215
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014216add map <map> <key> <value>
14217 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14218 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014219 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14220 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14221 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014222
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014223clear counters
14224 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14225 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14226 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14227 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14228 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14229
14230clear counters all
14231 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14232 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14233 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14234
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014235clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014236 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14237 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14238 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014239
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014240clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014241 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14242 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14243 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014244
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014245clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14246 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14247
14248 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14249 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14250 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14251 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14252 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14253 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14254
14255 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14256
14257 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14258 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14259 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14260 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14261 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14262 the ACLs :
14263
14264 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14265 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14266 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14267 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14268 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14269 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14270
14271 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014272 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14273 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014274
14275 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014276 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014277 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014278 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14279 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14280 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14281 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014282
14283 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14284
14285 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014286 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014287 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14288 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014289 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14290 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14291 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014292
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014293del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14294 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014295 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14296 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14297 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14298 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014299
14300del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014301 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014302 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14303 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14304 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14305 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014306
14307disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014308 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14309
14310 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14311 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14312 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14313 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14314 re-enabled using enable agent.
14315
14316 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14317 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14318 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14319 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14320 otherwise unchanged.
14321
14322 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14323 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14324 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14325
14326 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14327 level "admin".
14328
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014329disable frontend <frontend>
14330 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14331 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14332 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14333 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14334 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14335 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14336 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14337 on the stats page.
14338
14339 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14340 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14341
14342 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14343 level "admin".
14344
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014345disable health <backend>/<server>
14346 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14347 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14348 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14349 agent check forces it down.
14350
14351 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14352 level "admin".
14353
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014354disable server <backend>/<server>
14355 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14356 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14357 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14358 during the maintenance.
14359
14360 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14361 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14362
14363 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014364 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014365
14366 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14367 level "admin".
14368
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014369enable agent <backend>/<server>
14370 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14371
14372 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14373 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14374
14375 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14376 level "admin".
14377
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014378enable frontend <frontend>
14379 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14380 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14381 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14382 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14383 which was disabled.
14384
14385 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14386 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14387
14388 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14389 level "admin".
14390
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014391enable health <backend>/<server>
14392 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14393 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14394
14395 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14396 level "admin".
14397
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014398enable server <backend>/<server>
14399 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14400 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14401
14402 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014403 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014404
14405 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14406 level "admin".
14407
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014408get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014409get acl <acl> <value>
14410 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14411 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14412 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14413 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14414 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014415
14416 The first two words are:
14417
14418 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14419 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14420 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14421
14422 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14423
14424 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14425
14426 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14427
14428 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14429 interpretation of the case.
14430
14431 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14432 useful with regular expressions.
14433
14434 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14435 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14436
14437 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14438 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14439 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14440
14441 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14442
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014443get weight <backend>/<server>
14444 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14445 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14446 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14447 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14448 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014449 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014450
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014451help
14452 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14453 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014454
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014455prompt
14456 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14457 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14458 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14459 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14460 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14461 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14462 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14463 command.
14464
14465quit
14466 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014467
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014468set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014469 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14470 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14471 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014472
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014473set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014474 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14475 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14476 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14477 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14478 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014479 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14480 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14481
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014482set maxconn global <maxconn>
14483 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14484 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14485 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14486 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14487 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14488 setting.
14489
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014490set rate-limit connections global <value>
14491 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14492 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14493 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14494 is passed in number of connections per second.
14495
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014496set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14497 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14498 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014499 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14500 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014501
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014502set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14503 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14504 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14505 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14506 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14507
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014508set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14509 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14510 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14511 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14512 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14513 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14514
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014515set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14516 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14517 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14518 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14519
14520set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14521 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14522 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14523 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14524
14525set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14526 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14527 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14528 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14529 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14530 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14531 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14532 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14533 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14534
14535set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14536 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14537 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14538
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014539set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14540 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14541 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14542 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14543 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14544
14545 Example:
14546 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14547 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14548 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14549 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14550
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014551set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014552 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14553 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14554 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14555 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014556 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14557 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014558
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014559set timeout cli <delay>
14560 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14561 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14562 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14563
14564set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14565 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14566 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014567 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14568 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14569 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14570 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14571 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14572 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14573 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14574 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14575 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14576 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14577 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14578 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14579 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014580
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014581show errors [<iid>]
14582 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14583 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014584 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14585 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14586 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014587
14588 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14589 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14590 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14591 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14592 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14593 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14594 are reported too.
14595
14596 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14597 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14598 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14599 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14600 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14601 code.
14602
14603 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14604 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14605 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14606 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14607 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14608 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14609 line.
14610
14611 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014612 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14613 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014614 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14615 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14616
14617 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14618 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14619 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14620 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14621 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14622 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14623 00204+ minal\r\n
14624 00211 \r\n
14625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014626 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014627 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14628 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14629 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14630 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14631 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14632 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014633
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014634show info
14635 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14636
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014637show map [<map>]
14638 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014639 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14640 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14641 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14642 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14643 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14644 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014645
14646show acl [<acl>]
14647 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014648 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14649 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14650 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14651 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14652 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014653
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014654show pools
14655 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14656 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14657 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14658 the pools.
14659
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014660show sess
14661 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014662 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14663 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14664
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014665show sess <id>
14666 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14667 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14668 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14669 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14670 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014671 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14672 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14673
14674 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14675 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014676
14677show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14678 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14679 possible to dump only selected items :
14680 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14681 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14682 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14683 for example:
14684 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14685 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14686 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14687
14688 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014689 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14690 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014691 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14692 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14693 Nbproc: 1
14694 Process_num: 1
14695 (...)
14696
14697 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14698 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14699 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14700 (...)
14701 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14702
14703 $
14704
14705 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14706 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14707 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14708 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014709 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014710
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014711show table
14712 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14713 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14714 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14715 entries currently in use.
14716
14717 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014718 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014719 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14720 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014721
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014722show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014723 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14724 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14725 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014726 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14727
14728 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14729 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14730 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14731 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14732 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14733
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014734 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14735 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14736 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14737 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14738 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14739 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14740
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014741
14742 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014743 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14744 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014745
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014746 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014747 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014748 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014749 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14750 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14751 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14752 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014753
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014754 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014755 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014756 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14757 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014758
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014759 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14760 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014761 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014762 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14763 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014764
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014765 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14766 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014767 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014768 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14769 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14770
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014771 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14772 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14773 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14774 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14775 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14776
14777 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14778 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14779 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014780 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14781 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014782 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14783 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014784
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014785shutdown frontend <frontend>
14786 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14787 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14788 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14789 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14790 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14791 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14792 once it is terminated.
14793
14794 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14795 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14796
14797 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14798 level "admin".
14799
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014800shutdown session <id>
14801 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14802 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14803 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14804 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14805 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14806 flag in the logs.
14807
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014808shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014809 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14810 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14811 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14812 'K' flag in the logs.
14813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014814/*
14815 * Local variables:
14816 * fill-column: 79
14817 * End:
14818 */